blob: 380fb836b7269fc25bf1c784bafa979a2fedbbcb [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau15480d72014-06-19 21:10:58 +02005 version 1.6
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau9229f122014-06-19 21:01:06 +02007 2014/06/19
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200627. Using ACLs and fetching samples
637.1. ACL basics
647.1.1. Matching booleans
657.1.2. Matching integers
667.1.3. Matching strings
677.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
687.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
697.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
707.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
717.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200727.3.1. Converters
737.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
747.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
757.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
767.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
777.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200787.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079
808. Logging
818.1. Log levels
828.2. Log formats
838.2.1. Default log format
848.2.2. TCP log format
858.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100868.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100878.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200888.3. Advanced logging options
898.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
908.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
918.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
928.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
938.4. Timing events
948.5. Session state at disconnection
958.6. Non-printable characters
968.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
978.8. Capturing HTTP headers
988.9. Examples of logs
99
1009. Statistics and monitoring
1019.1. CSV format
1029.2. Unix Socket commands
103
104
1051. Quick reminder about HTTP
106----------------------------
107
108When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
109fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
110on almost anything found in the contents.
111
112However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
113formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
114correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
115
116
1171.1. The HTTP transaction model
118-------------------------------
119
120The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100121to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
123connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
124will involve a new connection :
125
126 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
127
128In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
129establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
130by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
131length.
132
133Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
134to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
135however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
136response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
137header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
138
139 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
140
141Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
142power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
143but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200144a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145
146A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
147keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
148second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
149page :
150
151 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
152
153This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
154latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
155correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
156the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100157server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100159By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
160connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
161leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
162start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200163
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100164HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
165 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
166 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
167 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
168 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
169 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
170 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
171
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172
1731.2. HTTP request
174-----------------
175
176First, let's consider this HTTP request :
177
178 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100179 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
181 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
182 3 User-agent: my small browser
183 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
184 5 Accept: image/png
185
186
1871.2.1. The Request line
188-----------------------
189
190Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
191
192 - a METHOD : GET
193 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
194 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
195
196All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
197which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
198followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
199is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
200desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
201the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
202
203The URI itself can have several forms :
204
205 - A "relative URI" :
206
207 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
208
209 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
210 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
211
212 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
213
214 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
215
216 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
217 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
218 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
219 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
220 must accept this form too.
221
222 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
223 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
224 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100225
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200226 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
227 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
228 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
229 other protocols too.
230
231In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
232mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
233on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
234It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
235specific to the language, framework or application in use.
236
237
2381.2.2. The request headers
239--------------------------
240
241The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
242beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
243an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
244Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
245values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
246encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
247the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
248define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
249
250Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
251their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
252"Connection:" header).
253
254The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
255that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
256is one valid form of empty line.
257
258Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
259headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
260about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
261application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
262
263Important note:
264 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
265 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
266 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
267 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
268
269
2701.3. HTTP response
271------------------
272
273An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
274messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
275
276 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100277 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200278 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
279 2 Content-length: 350
280 3 Content-Type: text/html
281
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200282As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
283codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
284response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100285continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
286the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
287following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
288sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
289(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
290correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
291such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
292state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
293over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
294if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
295information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200296
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200297
2981.3.1. The Response line
299------------------------
300
301Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
302
303 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
304 - a status code : 200
305 - a reason : OK
306
307The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200308 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200309 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
310 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
311 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
312 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
313
314Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100315"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200316found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
317messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
318or "Authentication Required".
319
320Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
321
322 Code When / reason
323 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
324 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
325 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
326 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100327 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
328 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200329 400 for an invalid or too large request
330 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
331 accessing the stats page)
332 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
333 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
334 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
335 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
336 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
337 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
338 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
339 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
340 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
341
342The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3434.2).
344
345
3461.3.2. The response headers
347---------------------------
348
349Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
350the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
351details.
352
353
3542. Configuring HAProxy
355----------------------
356
3572.1. Configuration file format
358------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200359
360HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
361
362 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
363 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
364 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
365 "frontend" and "backend".
366
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100367The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
368referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
369delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100370preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100371escaped by doubling them.
372
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200373
3742.2. Time format
375----------------
376
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100377Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100378values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
379otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
380numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
381for every keyword. Supported units are :
382
383 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
384 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
385 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
386 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
387 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
388 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
389
390
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003912.3. Examples
392-------------
393
394 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
395 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
396 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
397 global
398 daemon
399 maxconn 256
400
401 defaults
402 mode http
403 timeout connect 5000ms
404 timeout client 50000ms
405 timeout server 50000ms
406
407 frontend http-in
408 bind *:80
409 default_backend servers
410
411 backend servers
412 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
413
414
415 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
416 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
417 global
418 daemon
419 maxconn 256
420
421 defaults
422 mode http
423 timeout connect 5000ms
424 timeout client 50000ms
425 timeout server 50000ms
426
427 listen http-in
428 bind *:80
429 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
430
431
432Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
433
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100434 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200435
436
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004373. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200438--------------------
439
440Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
441are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
442of them have command-line equivalents.
443
444The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
445
446 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200447 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200448 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200449 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200450 - daemon
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900451 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200452 - gid
453 - group
454 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100455 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200456 - nbproc
457 - pidfile
458 - uid
459 - ulimit-n
460 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200461 - stats
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100462 - ssl-server-verify
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200463 - node
464 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100465 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100466
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200467 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200468 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200469 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200470 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100471 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100472 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100473 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200474 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200475 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200476 - maxsslrate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200477 - noepoll
478 - nokqueue
479 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100480 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300481 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200482 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200483 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200484 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100485 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100486 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200487 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100488 - tune.idletimer
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100489 - tune.maxaccept
490 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200491 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200492 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100493 - tune.rcvbuf.client
494 - tune.rcvbuf.server
495 - tune.sndbuf.client
496 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100497 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100498 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200499 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100500 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200501 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100502 - tune.zlib.memlevel
503 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100504
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200505 * Debugging
506 - debug
507 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200508
509
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005103.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200511------------------------------------
512
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200513ca-base <dir>
514 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200515 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
516 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200517
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200518chroot <jail dir>
519 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
520 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
521 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
522 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
523 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
524 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100525
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100526cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
527 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
528 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
529 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100530 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
531 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
532 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
533 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
534 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
535 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
536 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
537 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
538 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
539 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100540
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200541crt-base <dir>
542 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
543 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
544 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
545
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200546daemon
547 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
548 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
549 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
550
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900551external-check
552 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
553 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
554 See "option external-check".
555
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200556gid <number>
557 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
558 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
559 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100560 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
561 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200562 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100563
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200564group <group name>
565 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
566 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100567
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200568log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200569 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
570 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100571 configured with "log global".
572
573 <address> can be one of:
574
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100575 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100576 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
577 port).
578
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100579 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
580 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
581 port).
582
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100583 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
584 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
585 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
586 writeable).
587
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100588 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
589 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and
590 optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done
591 in Bourne shell.
592
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200593 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
594 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
595 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
596 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
597 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
598 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
599 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
600 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
601 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
602 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
603 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
604
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100605 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200606
607 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
608 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
609 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
610
611 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200612 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
613 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
614 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
615 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
616 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
617 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200618
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200619 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200620
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100621log-send-hostname [<string>]
622 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
623 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
624 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
625 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
626 the logs.
627
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000628log-tag <string>
629 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
630 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
631 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100632 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000633
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200634nbproc <number>
635 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
636 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
637 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
638 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
639 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
640
641pidfile <pidfile>
642 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
643 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
644 starting the process. See also "daemon".
645
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100646stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200647 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
648 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
649 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
650 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
651 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
652 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100653 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200654 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
655 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200656
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100657ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
658 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
659 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300660 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100661 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
662 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
663 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
664 "bind" keyword for more information.
665
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100666ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
667 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
668 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
669 keyword to see available options.
670
671 Example:
672 global
673 ssl-default-bind-options no-sslv3 no-tls-tickets
674
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100675ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
676 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
677 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300678 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100679 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
680 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
681 information.
682
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100683ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
684 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
685 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
686 keyword to see available options.
687
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100688ssl-server-verify [none|required]
689 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
690 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
691 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
692
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200693stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
694 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
695 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
696 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
697 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200698
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200699 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
700 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
701 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200702
703stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
704 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
705 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100706 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200707
708stats maxconn <connections>
709 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
710 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
711
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200712uid <number>
713 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
714 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
715 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
716 one. See also "gid" and "user".
717
718ulimit-n <number>
719 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
720 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
721 option.
722
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100723unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
724 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
725
726 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
727 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
728 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
729 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
730 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
731 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
732 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
733 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
734 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
735 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
736
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200737user <user name>
738 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
739 See also "uid" and "group".
740
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200741node <name>
742 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
743
744 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
745 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
746 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
747 traffic.
748
749description <text>
750 Add a text that describes the instance.
751
752 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
753 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
754 "<" and ">" characters.
755
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200756
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007573.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200758-----------------------
759
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200760max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
761 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
762 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
763 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
764 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
765 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
766 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
767 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
768 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
769
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200770maxconn <number>
771 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
772 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
773 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +0200774 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
775 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
776 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
777 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +0100778 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
779 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
780 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
781 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
782 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200783
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200784maxconnrate <number>
785 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
786 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
787 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
788 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
789 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
790 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
791 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
792 fairness.
793
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100794maxcomprate <number>
795 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300796 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100797 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
798 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
799 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
800 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
801 default value.
802
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100803maxcompcpuusage <number>
804 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
805 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
806 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
807 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
808 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
809 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
810 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
811 process down and from introducing high latencies.
812
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100813maxpipes <number>
814 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
815 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
816 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
817 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
818 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
819 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
820
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200821maxsessrate <number>
822 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
823 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
824 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
825 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
826 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
827 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
828 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
829 fairness.
830
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200831maxsslconn <number>
832 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
833 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
834 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
835 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
836 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
837 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
838 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +0100839 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
840 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
841 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
842 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
843 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
844 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
845 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200846
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200847maxsslrate <number>
848 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
849 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
850 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
851 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
852 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
853 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
854 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
855 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
856 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
857 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
858
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100859maxzlibmem <number>
860 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
861 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
862 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100863 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
864 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
865 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
866
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200867noepoll
868 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
869 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100870 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200871
872nokqueue
873 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
874 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
875 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
876
877nopoll
878 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
879 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100880 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100881 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200882
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100883nosplice
884 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
885 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
886 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100887 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100888 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
889 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
890 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
891 "option splice-response".
892
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300893nogetaddrinfo
894 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
895 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
896
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200897spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +0900898 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
899 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
900 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
901 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
902 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
903 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200904
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +0100905tune.buffers.limit <number>
906 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
907 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
908 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
909 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
910 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
911 behaviour. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
912 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
913 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
914 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
915 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
916 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
917 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
918 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
919 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
920 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
921
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +0100922tune.buffers.reserve <number>
923 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
924 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
925 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
926 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
927
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200928tune.bufsize <number>
929 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
930 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
931 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
932 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
933 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
934 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
935 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
936 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400937 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
938 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
939 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200940
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200941tune.chksize <number>
942 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
943 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
944 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
945 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
946 checks whenever possible.
947
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100948tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
949 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
950 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
951 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
952 this value. The default value is 1.
953
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100954tune.http.cookielen <number>
955 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
956 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
957 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
958 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
959 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
960 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
961 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
962 to change this value.
963
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200964tune.http.maxhdr <number>
965 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
966 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
967 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
968 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
969 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
970 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
971 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
972 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
973 limit too high.
974
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100975tune.idletimer <timeout>
976 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
977 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
978 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
979 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
980 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
981 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
982 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
983 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
984 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
985
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100986tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +0100987 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
988 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
989 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
990 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
991 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
992 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
993 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
994 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
995 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
996 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100997
998tune.maxpollevents <number>
999 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1000 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1001 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1002 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1003 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1004
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001005tune.maxrewrite <number>
1006 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1007 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1008 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1009 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1010 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1011 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1012 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1013 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1014 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1015 bufsize.
1016
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001017tune.pipesize <number>
1018 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1019 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1020 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1021 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1022 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1023 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1024
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001025tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1026tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1027 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1028 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1029 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1030 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1031 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1032 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1033 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1034
1035tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1036tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1037 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1038 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1039 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1040 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1041 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1042 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1043 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1044 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1045 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1046 notifying haproxy again.
1047
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001048tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001049 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1050 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1051 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001052 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001053 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1054 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1055 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1056 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1057 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001058 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1059 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001060
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001061tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1062 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1063 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1064 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1065 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1066 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1067 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1068
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001069tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1070 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001071 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001072 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1073 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1074 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1075 being used for too long.
1076
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001077tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1078 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1079 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1080 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1081 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1082 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1083 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1084 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1085 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1086 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1087 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001088 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1089 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001090
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001091tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1092 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1093 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1094 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1095 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1096 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1097 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1098 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
1099 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied via the certificate file.
1100
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001101tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1102 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001103 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001104 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1105 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1106 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1107
1108tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1109 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1110 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1111 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1112 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001113
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011143.3. Debugging
1115--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001116
1117debug
1118 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1119 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1120 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1121 system startup.
1122
1123quiet
1124 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1125 line argument "-q".
1126
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001127
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011283.4. Userlists
1129--------------
1130It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1131http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1132it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1133
1134userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001135 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001136 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1137
1138group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001139 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001140 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1141 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1142
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001143user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1144 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001145 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1146 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001147 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1148 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001149 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001150 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001151
1152
1153 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001154 userlist L1
1155 group G1 users tiger,scott
1156 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001157
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001158 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1159 user scott insecure-password elgato
1160 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001161
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001162 userlist L2
1163 group G1
1164 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001165
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001166 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1167 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1168 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001169
1170 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001171
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001172
11733.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001174----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001175It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
1176haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
1177pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
1178identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
1179or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
1180Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
1181known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
1182the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
1183process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
1184during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
1185tables.
1186
1187peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001188 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001189 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1190
1191peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1192 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1193 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1194 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1195 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1196 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1197 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1198
1199 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1200 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1201
1202 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1203 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1204 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1205 across all peers.
1206
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001207 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
1208 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and optionally
1209 enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
1210
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001211 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001212 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001213 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1214 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1215 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001216
1217 backend mybackend
1218 mode tcp
1219 balance roundrobin
1220 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1221 stick on src
1222
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001223 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1224 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001225
1226
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012274. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001228----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001229
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001230Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
1231 - defaults <name>
1232 - frontend <name>
1233 - backend <name>
1234 - listen <name>
1235
1236A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1237its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1238section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001239section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001240
1241A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1242connections.
1243
1244A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1245to forward incoming connections.
1246
1247A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1248parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1249
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001250All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1251'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1252case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1253
1254Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1255logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1256proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1257However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1258name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1259
1260Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1261and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001262bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001263protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1264modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1265arbitrary criteria.
1266
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001267In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1268a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1269the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1270
1271 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1272 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1273 between responses and new requests.
1274
1275 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1276 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1277 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1278 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1279
1280 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1281 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1282 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1283
1284 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1285 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1286 client-facing connection remains open.
1287
1288 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1289 after the end of the response.
1290
1291The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1292frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1293following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1294weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1295
1296 Backend mode
1297
1298 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1299 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1300 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1301 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1302 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1303 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1304 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1305 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1306 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1307 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1308 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1309
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001310
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001311
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013124.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1313--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001314
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001315The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1316limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1317they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1318limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001319marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001320option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001321and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1322with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1323specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001324
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001325
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001326 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1327------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1328acl - X X X
1329appsession - - X X
1330backlog X X X -
1331balance X - X X
1332bind - X X -
1333bind-process X X X X
1334block - X X X
1335capture cookie - X X -
1336capture request header - X X -
1337capture response header - X X -
1338clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001339compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001340contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1341cookie X - X X
1342default-server X - X X
1343default_backend X X X -
1344description - X X X
1345disabled X X X X
1346dispatch - - X X
1347enabled X X X X
1348errorfile X X X X
1349errorloc X X X X
1350errorloc302 X X X X
1351-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1352errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001353force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001354fullconn X - X X
1355grace X X X X
1356hash-type X - X X
1357http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001358http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001359http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001360http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001361http-response - X X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001362http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001363id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001364ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001365log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01001366log-format X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001367log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001368max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001369maxconn X X X -
1370mode X X X X
1371monitor fail - X X -
1372monitor-net X X X -
1373monitor-uri X X X -
1374option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1375option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1376option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1377option allbackups (*) X - X X
1378option checkcache (*) X - X X
1379option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1380option contstats (*) X X X -
1381option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1382option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1383option forceclose (*) X X X X
1384-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1385option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001386option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001387option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001388option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001389option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001390option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001391option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1392option httpchk X - X X
1393option httpclose (*) X X X X
1394option httplog X X X X
1395option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001396option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001397option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001398option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001399option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1400option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1401option logasap (*) X X X -
1402option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001403option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001404option nolinger (*) X X X X
1405option originalto X X X X
1406option persist (*) X - X X
1407option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001408option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001409option smtpchk X - X X
1410option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1411option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1412option splice-request (*) X X X X
1413option splice-response (*) X X X X
1414option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1415option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1416-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001417option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001418option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1419option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1420option tcpka X X X X
1421option tcplog X X X X
1422option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001423external-check command X - X X
1424external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001425persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1426rate-limit sessions X X X -
1427redirect - X X X
1428redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1429redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1430reqadd - X X X
1431reqallow - X X X
1432reqdel - X X X
1433reqdeny - X X X
1434reqiallow - X X X
1435reqidel - X X X
1436reqideny - X X X
1437reqipass - X X X
1438reqirep - X X X
1439reqisetbe - X X X
1440reqitarpit - X X X
1441reqpass - X X X
1442reqrep - X X X
1443-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1444reqsetbe - X X X
1445reqtarpit - X X X
1446retries X - X X
1447rspadd - X X X
1448rspdel - X X X
1449rspdeny - X X X
1450rspidel - X X X
1451rspideny - X X X
1452rspirep - X X X
1453rsprep - X X X
1454server - - X X
1455source X - X X
1456srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001457stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001458stats auth X - X X
1459stats enable X - X X
1460stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001461stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001462stats realm X - X X
1463stats refresh X - X X
1464stats scope X - X X
1465stats show-desc X - X X
1466stats show-legends X - X X
1467stats show-node X - X X
1468stats uri X - X X
1469-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1470stick match - - X X
1471stick on - - X X
1472stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001473stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001474stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001475tcp-check connect - - X X
1476tcp-check expect - - X X
1477tcp-check send - - X X
1478tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001479tcp-request connection - X X -
1480tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001481tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001482tcp-response content - - X X
1483tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001484timeout check X - X X
1485timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001486timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001487timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1488timeout connect X - X X
1489timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1490timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1491timeout http-request X X X X
1492timeout queue X - X X
1493timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001494timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001495timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1496timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001497timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001498transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001499unique-id-format X X X -
1500unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001501use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001502use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001503------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1504 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001505
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001506
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015074.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1508---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001509
1510This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1511
1512
1513acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1514 Declare or complete an access list.
1515 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1516 no | yes | yes | yes
1517 Example:
1518 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1519 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1520 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1521
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001522 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001523
1524
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001525appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1526 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001527 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1528 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1529 no | no | yes | yes
1530 Arguments :
1531 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1532 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1533
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001534 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001535 checked in each cookie value.
1536
1537 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1538 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1539 milliseconds.
1540
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001541 request-learn
1542 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1543 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1544 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1545 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1546 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1547 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1548
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001549 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1550 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1551 data following this prefix.
1552
1553 Example :
1554 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1555
1556 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1557 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1558
1559 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1560 2 modes are currently supported :
1561 - path-parameters :
1562 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1563 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1564 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1565 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1566 - query-string :
1567 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1568 query string.
1569
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001570 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1571 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1572 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1573 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001574 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1575 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1576 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001577 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1578 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1579
1580 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1581
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001582 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1583 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1584 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1585
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001586 Example :
1587 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1588
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001589 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1590 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001591
1592
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001593backlog <conns>
1594 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1595 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1596 yes | yes | yes | no
1597 Arguments :
1598 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1599 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001600 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001601
1602 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1603 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1604 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1605 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1606 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1607 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1608 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1609 backlog parameter.
1610
1611 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1612 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1613 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1614
1615 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1616
1617
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001618balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001619balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001620 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1621 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1622 yes | no | yes | yes
1623 Arguments :
1624 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1625 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1626 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1627 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1628
1629 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1630 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1631 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1632 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001633 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001634 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001635 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1636 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1637 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1638 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1639 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1640 it, so that you don't worry.
1641
1642 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1643 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1644 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1645 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1646 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1647 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1648 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1649 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001650
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001651 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1652 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1653 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1654 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1655 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1656 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1657 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1658 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1659
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001660 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001661 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001662 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1663 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001664 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001665 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1666 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1667 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1668 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1669 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001670 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1671 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1672 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1673 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1674 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1675 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001676
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001677 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1678 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1679 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1680 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1681 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1682 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1683 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1684 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001685 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001686 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001687 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1688 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1689 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001690
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001691 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1692 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1693 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1694 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1695 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1696 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1697 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1698 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1699 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1700 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1701 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1702 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001703
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001704 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001705 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1706 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1707 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1708 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1709 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1710 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1711 URIs start with a leading "/".
1712
1713 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1714 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1715 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1716 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1717
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001718 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001719 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1720
1721 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001722 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1723 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001724 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
1725 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
1726 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
1727 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001728 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001729 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
1730 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001731
1732 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1733 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1734 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1735 server will receive the request.
1736
1737 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1738 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1739 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1740 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1741 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001742 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1743 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1744 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001745
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001746 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1747 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1748 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1749 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1750 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001751
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001752 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001753 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1754 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1755 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1756
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001757 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1758 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1759 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1760
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001761 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001762 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001763 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1764 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1765 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1766 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1767 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1768 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001769 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001770 used instead.
1771
1772 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1773 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1774 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1775 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1776
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001777 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1778 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1779 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1780
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001781 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001782
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001783 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001784 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1785 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001786
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001787 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1788 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1789 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001790
1791 Examples :
1792 balance roundrobin
1793 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001794 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001795 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1796 balance hdr(host)
1797 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001798
1799 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1800 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1801
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001802 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001803 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1804 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1805 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1806 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1807
1808 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1809 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1810 defaults to 16 kB.
1811
1812 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1813 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1814
1815 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1816 Round Robin.
1817
1818 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1819 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1820 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1821 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1822
1823 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1824
1825 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001826 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001827 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1828 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1829 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001830
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001831 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1832 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001833
1834
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001835bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1836bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001837 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1838 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1839 no | yes | yes | no
1840 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001841 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1842 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1843 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1844 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001845 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001846 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
1847 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
1848 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
1849 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
1850 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
1851 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
1852 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02001853 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
1854 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
1855 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
1856 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
1857 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
1858 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
1859 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01001860 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
1861 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
1862 be listening.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001863 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
1864 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
1865 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
1866 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001867
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001868 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1869 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001870 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1871 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1872 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001873 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1874 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1875 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1876 the range.
1877
1878 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1879 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1880 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1881 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1882 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1883 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1884 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001885 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001886 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001887
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001888 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1889 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1890 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1891 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1892 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1893 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1894 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1895 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1896
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001897 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1898 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1899 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1900 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001901
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001902 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1903 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1904 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1905 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1906 in a frontend.
1907
1908 Example :
1909 listen http_proxy
1910 bind :80,:443
1911 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001912 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001913
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001914 listen http_https_proxy
1915 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001916 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001917
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001918 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
1919 bind ipv6@:80
1920 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
1921 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
1922
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001923 listen external_bind_app1
1924 bind fd@${FD_APP1}
1925
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001926 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001927 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001928
1929
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001930bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001931 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1932 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1933 yes | yes | yes | yes
1934 Arguments :
1935 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1936 may be used to override a default value.
1937
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001938 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001939 option may be combined with other numbers.
1940
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001941 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001942 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1943 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1944 missing from all processes.
1945
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001946 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001947 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02001948 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
1949 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
1950 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
1951 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001952
1953 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1954 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1955 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1956 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1957 and 'even' instances.
1958
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001959 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
1960 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
1961 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
1962 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001963
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02001964 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
1965 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
1966
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02001967 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
1968 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
1969 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
1970
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001971 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1972 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1973
1974 Example :
1975 listen app_ip1
1976 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001977 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001978
1979 listen app_ip2
1980 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001981 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001982
1983 listen management
1984 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001985 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001986
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001987 listen management
1988 bind 10.0.0.4:80
1989 bind-process 1-4
1990
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02001991 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001992
1993
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001994block { if | unless } <condition>
1995 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1996 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1997 no | yes | yes | yes
1998
1999 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2000 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002001 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002002 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002003 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
2004 "block" statements per instance.
2005
2006 Example:
2007 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2008 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2009 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2010 block if invalid_src || local_dst
2011
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002012 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002013
2014
2015capture cookie <name> len <length>
2016 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2017 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2018 no | yes | yes | no
2019 Arguments :
2020 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2021 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2022 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2023 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
2024 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
2025
2026 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2027 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2028 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2029 right if it exceeds <length>.
2030
2031 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2032 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2033 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2034 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2035
2036 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2037 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2038 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2039
2040 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2041 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2042 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002043 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2044 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2045 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002046
2047 Example:
2048 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2049
2050 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002051 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002052
2053
2054capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002055 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002056 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2057 no | yes | yes | no
2058 Arguments :
2059 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002060 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002061 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2062 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2063 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2064
2065 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2066 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2067 it exceeds <length>.
2068
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002069 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002070 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2071 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002072 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2073 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2074 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2075 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002076 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002077 environments to find where the request came from.
2078
2079 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2080 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2081 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2082 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002083
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002084 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2085 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2086 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2087 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2088 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002089
2090 Example:
2091 capture request header Host len 15
2092 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
2093 capture request header Referrer len 15
2094
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002095 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002096 about logging.
2097
2098
2099capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002100 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002101 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2102 no | yes | yes | no
2103 Arguments :
2104 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002105 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002106 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2107 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2108 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2109
2110 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2111 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2112 it exceeds <length>.
2113
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002114 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002115 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2116 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2117 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002118 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2119 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2120 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2121 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002122
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002123 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2124 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2125 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2126 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2127 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002128
2129 Example:
2130 capture response header Content-length len 9
2131 capture response header Location len 15
2132
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002133 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002134 about logging.
2135
2136
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002137clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002138 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2139 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2140 yes | yes | yes | no
2141 Arguments :
2142 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2143 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2144 as explained at the top of this document.
2145
2146 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2147 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2148 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2149 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2150 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2151 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2152 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2153 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002154 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002155 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2156 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2157
2158 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2159 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2160 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2161 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2162 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2163 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2164
2165 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2166 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2167
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002168 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2169 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002170
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002171compression algo <algorithm> ...
2172compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002173compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002174 Enable HTTP compression.
2175 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2176 yes | yes | yes | yes
2177 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002178 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2179 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2180 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2181
2182 The currently supported algorithms are :
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002183 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002184 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2185 data.
2186
2187 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
2188 support for zlib was built in.
2189
2190 deflate same as gzip, but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2191 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many browsers
2192 and no support at all from recent ones. It is strongly
2193 recommended not to use it for anything else than experimentation.
2194 This setting is only available when support for zlib was built
2195 in.
2196
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002197 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002198 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002199 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2200 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2201 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2202 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2203 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002204
2205 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2206 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2207 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2208 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2209 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002210 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2211 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2212 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2213 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2214 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002215 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2216 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002217
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002218 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002219 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2220 "Accept-Encoding" header
2221 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002222 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002223 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2224 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002225 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2226 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2227 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2228 "multipart"
2229 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2230 header
2231 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2232 and later
2233 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2234 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002235
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002236 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2237 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002238
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002239 Examples :
2240 compression algo gzip
2241 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002242
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002243contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002244 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2245 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2246 yes | no | yes | yes
2247 Arguments :
2248 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2249 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2250 as explained at the top of this document.
2251
2252 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002253 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002254 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002255 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2256 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2257 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2258 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2259
2260 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2261 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2262 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2263 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2264 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2265 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2266
2267 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2268 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2269 instead.
2270
2271 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2272 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2273
2274
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002275cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002276 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2277 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002278 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2279 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2280 yes | no | yes | yes
2281 Arguments :
2282 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2283 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2284 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2285 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2286 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2287 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2288 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2289 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2290 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2291
2292 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2293 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2294 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2295 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2296 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2297 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2298 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2299 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2300 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2301 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2302 "insert" and "prefix".
2303
2304 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002305 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002306
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002307 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002308 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2309 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2310 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2311 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2312 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2313 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2314 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2315 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2316 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2317 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002318
2319 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2320 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2321 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2322 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2323 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2324 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2325 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2326 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2327 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2328 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002329 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2330 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2331 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002332
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002333 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2334 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2335 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002336 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2337 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2338 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2339 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002340 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2341 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2342 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002343
2344 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2345 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2346 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2347 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2348 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2349 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2350 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2351 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2352 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2353
2354 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2355 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2356 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2357 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2358 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2359 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2360 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2361 persistence cookie in the cache.
2362 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2363
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002364 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2365 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2366 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2367 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2368 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2369 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2370 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2371 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2372 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2373 they logout.
2374
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002375 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2376 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2377 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2378 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2379
2380 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2381 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2382 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2383 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2384 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2385 this attribute.
2386
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002387 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002388 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002389 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2390 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2391 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2392 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2393 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2394 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002395
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002396 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2397 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2398 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2399 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2400 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2401 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2402 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2403 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2404 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2405 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2406 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2407 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2408 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2409 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2410 the site.
2411
2412 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2413 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2414 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2415 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2416 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2417 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2418 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2419 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2420 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2421 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2422 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2423 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2424 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2425 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2426 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2427 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2428
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002429 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2430 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2431 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2432 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002433
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002434 Examples :
2435 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2436 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2437 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002438 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002439
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002440 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002441 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002442
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002443
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002444default-server [param*]
2445 Change default options for a server in a backend
2446 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2447 yes | no | yes | yes
2448 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002449 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2450 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2451 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2452 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002453
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002454 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002455 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2456
2457 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002458
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002459
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002460default_backend <backend>
2461 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2462 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2463 yes | yes | yes | no
2464 Arguments :
2465 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2466
2467 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2468 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2469 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2470 will catch all undetermined requests.
2471
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002472 Example :
2473
2474 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2475 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2476 default_backend dynamic
2477
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002478 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2479
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002480
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002481description <string>
2482 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2483 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2484 no | yes | yes | yes
2485 Arguments : string
2486
2487 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2488 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2489 it describes.
2490 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2491
2492
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002493disabled
2494 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2495 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2496 yes | yes | yes | yes
2497 Arguments : none
2498
2499 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2500 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2501 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2502 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2503 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2504 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2505 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2506
2507 See also : "enabled"
2508
2509
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002510dispatch <address>:<port>
2511 Set a default server address
2512 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2513 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002514 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002515
2516 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2517 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2518 during start-up.
2519
2520 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2521 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2522 possible with normal servers.
2523
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002524 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002525 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2526 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2527 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2528 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2529
2530 See also : "server"
2531
2532
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002533enabled
2534 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2535 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2536 yes | yes | yes | yes
2537 Arguments : none
2538
2539 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2540 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2541
2542 See also : "disabled"
2543
2544
2545errorfile <code> <file>
2546 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2547 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2548 yes | yes | yes | yes
2549 Arguments :
2550 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002551 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002552
2553 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002554 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002555 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002556 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2557 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002558
2559 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2560 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2561 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2562
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002563 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2564
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002565 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2566 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2567 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2568 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2569
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002570 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2571 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2572 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2573 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2574 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2575 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2576
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002577 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2578 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2579 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002580 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002581 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2582
2583 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2584
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002585 Example :
2586 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02002587 errorfile 408 /dev/null # workaround Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002588 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2589 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2590
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002591
2592errorloc <code> <url>
2593errorloc302 <code> <url>
2594 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2595 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2596 yes | yes | yes | yes
2597 Arguments :
2598 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002599 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002600
2601 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2602 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2603 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2604 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2605 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2606
2607 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2608 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2609 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2610
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002611 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2612
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002613 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2614 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2615 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2616 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2617 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2618 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2619 request.
2620
2621 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2622
2623
2624errorloc303 <code> <url>
2625 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2626 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2627 yes | yes | yes | yes
2628 Arguments :
2629 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2630 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2631
2632 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2633 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2634 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2635 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2636 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2637
2638 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2639 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2640 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2641
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002642 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2643
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002644 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2645 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2646 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2647 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002648 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002649
2650 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2651
2652
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002653force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2654 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2655 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2656 no | yes | yes | yes
2657
2658 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2659 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2660 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2661 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2662 marked down for maintenance operations.
2663
2664 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2665 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2666 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2667 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2668 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2669 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2670 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2671 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2672 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2673
2674 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2675 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2676 is used.
2677
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002678 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002679 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002680
2681
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002682fullconn <conns>
2683 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2684 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2685 yes | no | yes | yes
2686 Arguments :
2687 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2688 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2689
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002690 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002691 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002692 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002693 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2694 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2695 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2696 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2697 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002698 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002699
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002700 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2701 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01002702 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
2703 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
2704 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002705
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002706 Example :
2707 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2708 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2709 # connections.
2710 backend dynamic
2711 fullconn 10000
2712 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2713 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2714
2715 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2716
2717
2718grace <time>
2719 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2720 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002721 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002722 Arguments :
2723 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2724 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2725 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2726
2727 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2728 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002729 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002730 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2731
2732 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2733 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2734 simplify it.
2735
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002736
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002737hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002738 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2739 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2740 yes | no | yes | yes
2741 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002742 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
2743 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002744
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002745 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2746 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
2747 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
2748 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
2749 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
2750 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
2751 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
2752 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
2753 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
2754 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002755
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002756 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2757 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2758 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2759 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2760 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2761 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
2762 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
2763 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
2764 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
2765 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
2766 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
2767 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
2768 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002769 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
2770 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002771
2772 <function> is the hash function to be used :
2773
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002774 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002775 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
2776 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
2777 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002778 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
2779 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
2780 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002781
2782 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
2783 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002784 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
2785 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
2786 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
2787 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
2788
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01002789 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
2790 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
2791 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
2792 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
2793 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
2794 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
2795 parameter.
2796
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01002797 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
2798 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
2799 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
2800 used on strings.
2801
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002802 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
2803
2804 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
2805 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
2806 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
2807 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
2808 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
2809 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
2810 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
2811 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
2812 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
2813 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
2814 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
2815 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002816
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002817 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
2818 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
2819 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002820
2821 See also : "balance", "server"
2822
2823
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002824http-check disable-on-404
2825 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2826 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002827 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002828 Arguments : none
2829
2830 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2831 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2832 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2833 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2834 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2835 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2836 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2837 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002838 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2839 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2840 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2841
2842 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2843
2844
2845http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002846 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002847 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002848 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002849 Arguments :
2850 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2851 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002852 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002853 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2854 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2855 details on the supported keywords.
2856
2857 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2858 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2859 with the usual backslash ('\').
2860
2861 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2862 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2863 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2864 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2865 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2866
2867 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002868 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002869 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2870 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2871 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2872
2873 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002874 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002875 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2876 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2877 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2878 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2879
2880 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002881 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002882 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2883 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2884 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2885 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2886 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2887 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2888 trace).
2889
2890 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002891 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002892 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2893 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2894 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2895 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2896 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2897 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2898
2899 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2900 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2901 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2902 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2903 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2904 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2905 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2906 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2907
2908 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2909 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2910
2911 Examples :
2912 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002913 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002914
2915 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002916 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002917
2918 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002919 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002920
2921 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002922 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002923
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002924 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002925
2926
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002927http-check send-state
2928 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2929 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2930 yes | no | yes | yes
2931 Arguments : none
2932
2933 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2934 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2935 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2936 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2937 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2938
2939 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2940 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2941 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2942 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2943 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2944 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2945 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2946 checked in multiple backends.
2947
2948 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2949 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2950
2951 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2952 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2953 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2954 one fails.
2955
2956 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2957 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2958 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2959
2960 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2961 server's queue.
2962
2963 Example of a header received by the application server :
2964 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2965 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2966
2967 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2968
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002969http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002970 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002971 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06002972 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
2973 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02002974 set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
2975 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2976 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2977 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02002978 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
2979 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02002980 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002981 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002982 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2983
2984 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2985 no | yes | yes | yes
2986
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002987 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2988 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2989 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2990 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2991 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002992
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002993 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2994 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
2995 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
2996
2997 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2998 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
2999 are evaluated.
3000
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003001 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
3002 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
3003 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
3004 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
3005 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
3006 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
3007 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
3008 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
3009 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003010 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003011 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
3012
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003013 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
3014 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
3015 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
3016 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
3017 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
3018
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003019 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3020 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
3021 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01003022 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
3023 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003024
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003025 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3026 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3027 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
3028 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
3029 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
3030 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
3031 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
3032 the resulting header from a previous rule.
3033
3034 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3035 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3036 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreau85603282015-01-21 20:39:27 +01003037 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
3038 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003039
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003040 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3041 <name>.
3042
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003043 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3044 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3045 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3046 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3047 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3048 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3049 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3050 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3051
3052 Example:
3053
3054 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3055
3056 applied to:
3057
3058 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3059
3060 outputs:
3061
3062 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3063
3064 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3065
3066 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3067 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3068 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3069 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3070 header.
3071
3072 Example:
3073
3074 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3075
3076 applied to:
3077
3078 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3079
3080 outputs:
3081
3082 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3083
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003084 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3085 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3086 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3087 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3088 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3089 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3090 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3091 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3092
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003093 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3094 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3095 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3096 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3097 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3098 another equipment.
3099
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003100 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3101 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3102 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3103 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3104 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3105 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3106 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3107 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3108
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003109 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3110 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3111 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3112 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3113 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3114 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3115 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3116 admin privileges.
3117
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003118 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3119 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3120 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3121 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3122 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3123 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3124 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3125 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3126
3127 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3128 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3129 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3130 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3131 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3132 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3133
3134 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3135 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3136 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3137 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3138 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3139 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3140
3141 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3142 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3143 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3144 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3145 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3146 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3147 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3148 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3149 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3150
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02003151 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
3152 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
3153 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
3154 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
3155 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
3156 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
3157 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
3158 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
3159 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
3160 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
3161 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
3162 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
3163
3164 These actions take one or two arguments :
3165 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
3166 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
3167 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
3168 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
3169
3170 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
3171 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
3172 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
3173 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
3174
3175 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
3176 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
3177 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
3178 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
3179 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
3180 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
3181 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
3182 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
3183
3184 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
3185 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
3186 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
3187 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
3188 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
3189
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003190 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
3191
3192 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
3193 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
3194 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
3195 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003196
3197 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003198 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
3199 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
3200 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003201
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003202 http-request allow if nagios
3203 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
3204 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
3205 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003206
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003207 Example:
3208 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003209 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003210
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003211 Example:
3212 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
3213 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
3214 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
3215 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
3216 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
3217 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
3218 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
3219 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
3220 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
3221
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003222 Example:
3223 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
3224 acl add path /addacl
3225 acl del path /delacl
3226
3227 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3228
3229 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
3230 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
3231
3232 Example:
3233 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3234 acl setmap path /setmap
3235 acl delmap path /delmap
3236
3237 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3238
3239 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
3240 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
3241
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02003242 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
3243 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003244
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003245http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003246 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003247 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
3248 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003249 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
3250 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3251 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3252 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3253 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
3254 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02003255 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003256 Access control for Layer 7 responses
3257
3258 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3259 no | yes | yes | yes
3260
3261 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3262 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3263 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3264 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3265 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
3266 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
3267
3268 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3269 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
3270 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
3271 current section.
3272
3273 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3274 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
3275 rules are evaluated.
3276
3277 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3278 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3279 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
3280 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
3281 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
3282 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
3283 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
3284
3285 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3286 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3287 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
3288 external users.
3289
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003290 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3291 <name>.
3292
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003293 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3294 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3295 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3296 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3297 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3298 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3299 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3300 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
3301
3302 Example:
3303
3304 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
3305
3306 applied to:
3307
3308 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3309
3310 outputs:
3311
3312 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3313
3314 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
3315
3316 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3317 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3318 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3319 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3320 header.
3321
3322 Example:
3323
3324 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
3325
3326 applied to:
3327
3328 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
3329
3330 outputs:
3331
3332 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
3333
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003334 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3335 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3336 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3337 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3338 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3339 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3340 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3341 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3342
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003343 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3344 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3345 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3346 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3347 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3348 another equipment.
3349
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003350 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3351 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3352 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3353 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3354 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3355 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3356 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3357 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3358
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003359 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3360 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3361 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3362 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3363 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3364 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3365 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3366 admin privileges.
3367
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003368 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3369 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3370 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3371 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3372 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3373 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3374 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3375 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3376
3377 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3378 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3379 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3380 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3381 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3382 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3383
3384 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3385 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3386 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3387 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3388 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3389 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3390
3391 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3392 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3393 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3394 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3395 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3396 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3397 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3398 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3399 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3400
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003401 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
3402
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08003403 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003404 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
3405 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
3406 rules.
3407
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003408 Example:
3409 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
3410
3411 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3412
3413 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3414 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3415
3416 Example:
3417 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3418
3419 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3420
3421 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
3422 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
3423
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003424 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
3425 ACL usage.
3426
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003427
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05003428http-send-name-header [<header>]
3429 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
3430
3431 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3432 yes | no | yes | yes
3433
3434 Arguments :
3435
3436 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
3437
3438 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
3439 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
3440 is added with the header string proved.
3441
3442 See also : "server"
3443
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003444id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02003445 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
3446 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3447 no | yes | yes | yes
3448 Arguments : none
3449
3450 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
3451 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
3452 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003453
3454
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003455ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3456 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
3457 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3458 no | yes | yes | yes
3459
3460 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
3461 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
3462 and running).
3463
3464 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3465 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
3466 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003467 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003468 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
3469
3470 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
3471 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
3472
3473 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3474 "unless" condition is met.
3475
3476 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
3477
3478
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003479log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02003480log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003481no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003482 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
3483 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3484 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003485
3486 Prefix :
3487 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
3488 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
3489 prefix does not allow arguments.
3490
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003491 Arguments :
3492 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
3493 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
3494 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
3495 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
3496 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
3497 parameter.
3498
3499 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
3500 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
3501
3502 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
3503 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3504 standard syslog port).
3505
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01003506 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
3507 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3508 standard syslog port).
3509
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003510 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
3511 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
3512 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
3513 appropriately writeable).
3514
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003515 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
3516 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
3517 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
3518 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
3519
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02003520 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
3521 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
3522 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
3523 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
3524 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
3525 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
3526 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
3527 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
3528 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
3529 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
3530 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
3531
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003532 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
3533
3534 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
3535 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
3536 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
3537
3538 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
3539 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
3540 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003541 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
3542 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
3543 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
3544 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
3545 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003546
3547 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3548
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003549 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
3550 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
3551 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003552
3553 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
3554 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
3555 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
3556 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
3557
3558 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
3559 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003560
3561 Example :
3562 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003563 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
3564 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003565 log ${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514 local0 notice # send to local server
3566
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003567
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003568log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003569 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
3570 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3571 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003572
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003573 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
3574 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
3575 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
3576 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
3577 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003578
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003579log-tag <string>
3580 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
3581 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3582 yes | yes | yes | yes
3583
3584 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
3585 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
3586 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
3587 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
3588 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
3589 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
3590 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
3591 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
3592 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003593
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003594max-keep-alive-queue <value>
3595 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
3596 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3597 yes | no | yes | yes
3598
3599 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
3600 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
3601 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
3602 servers.
3603
3604 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
3605 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
3606 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
3607 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
3608 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
3609 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
3610 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
3611 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
3612 picking a different server.
3613
3614 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
3615 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
3616 even if they have to be queued.
3617
3618 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
3619 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
3620
3621
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003622maxconn <conns>
3623 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
3624 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3625 yes | yes | yes | no
3626 Arguments :
3627 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
3628 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
3629 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
3630 closes.
3631
3632 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
3633 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
3634 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
3635 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
3636 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
3637 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
3638 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
3639 properly tuned.
3640
3641 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
3642 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
3643 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
3644
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02003645 By default, this value is set to 2000.
3646
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003647 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
3648
3649
3650mode { tcp|http|health }
3651 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
3652 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3653 yes | yes | yes | yes
3654 Arguments :
3655 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
3656 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
3657 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
3658 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
3659
3660 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
3661 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
3662 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
3663 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
3664 brings HAProxy most of its value.
3665
3666 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003667 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
3668 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
3669 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
3670 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
3671 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
3672 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
3673 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003674
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003675 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
3676 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
3677 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003678
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003679 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003680 defaults http_instances
3681 mode http
3682
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003683 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003684
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003685
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003686monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003687 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003688 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3689 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003690 Arguments :
3691 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
3692 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003693 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003694 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
3695 backend and its backup.
3696
3697 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
3698 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
3699 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
3700 servers in a list of backends.
3701
3702 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
3703 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
3704 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
3705 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
3706 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
3707 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
3708 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003709 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
3710 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003711
3712 Example:
3713 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003714 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003715 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
3716 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
3717 monitor-uri /site_alive
3718 monitor fail if site_dead
3719
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003720 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003721
3722
3723monitor-net <source>
3724 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
3725 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3726 yes | yes | yes | no
3727 Arguments :
3728 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
3729 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
3730 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
3731 followed by a mask.
3732
3733 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
3734 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003735 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003736 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
3737
3738 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
3739 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
3740 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
3741 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003742 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
3743 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
3744 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003745
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003746 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
3747 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
3748 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
3749 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
3750 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
3751 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003752
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01003753 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
3754 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003755
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003756 Example :
3757 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
3758 frontend www
3759 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
3760
3761 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
3762
3763
3764monitor-uri <uri>
3765 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
3766 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3767 yes | yes | yes | no
3768 Arguments :
3769 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
3770 health status instead of forwarding the request.
3771
3772 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
3773 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
3774 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
3775 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
3776 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
3777 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
3778 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
3779 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
3780
3781 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
3782 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
3783 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
3784 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
3785 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
3786 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
3787
3788 Example :
3789 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
3790 frontend www
3791 mode http
3792 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
3793
3794 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
3795
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003796
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003797option abortonclose
3798no option abortonclose
3799 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
3800 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3801 yes | no | yes | yes
3802 Arguments : none
3803
3804 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
3805 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
3806 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
3807 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003808 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003809 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
3810 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
3811 encountered while delivering the response.
3812
3813 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
3814 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
3815 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
3816 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
3817 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
3818 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003819 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003820 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003821 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003822 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
3823 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
3824 still not served and not pollute the servers.
3825
3826 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
3827 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
3828 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
3829 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
3830 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
3831 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
3832 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
3833 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003834 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003835
3836 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3837 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3838
3839 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
3840
3841
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003842option accept-invalid-http-request
3843no option accept-invalid-http-request
3844 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
3845 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3846 yes | yes | yes | no
3847 Arguments : none
3848
3849 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3850 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3851 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3852 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3853 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3854 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3855 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3856 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003857 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
3858 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
3859 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
3860 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
3861 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
3862 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003863
3864 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3865 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3866 been confirmed.
3867
3868 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3869 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003870 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
3871 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003872 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3873
3874 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3875 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3876
3877 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
3878 stats socket.
3879
3880
3881option accept-invalid-http-response
3882no option accept-invalid-http-response
3883 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
3884 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3885 yes | no | yes | yes
3886 Arguments : none
3887
3888 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3889 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3890 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3891 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3892 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3893 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3894 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3895 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
3896 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
3897
3898 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3899 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3900 been confirmed.
3901
3902 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3903 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
3904 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
3905 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3906
3907 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3908 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3909
3910 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
3911 stats socket.
3912
3913
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003914option allbackups
3915no option allbackups
3916 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
3917 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3918 yes | no | yes | yes
3919 Arguments : none
3920
3921 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
3922 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
3923 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
3924 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
3925 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
3926 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
3927 order between the backup servers anymore.
3928
3929 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
3930 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
3931
3932 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3933 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3934
3935
3936option checkcache
3937no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08003938 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003939 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3940 yes | no | yes | yes
3941 Arguments : none
3942
3943 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3944 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003945 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003946 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3947 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003948 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003949
3950 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003951 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003952 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003953 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3954 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003955 to the client are :
3956 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003957 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003958 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003959 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3960 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3961 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3962 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3963 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3964 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3965 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3966 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3967 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3968 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3969 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3970
3971 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003972 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003973 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003974 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003975 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3976
3977 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3978 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003979 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003980 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3981
3982 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3983 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3984
3985
3986option clitcpka
3987no option clitcpka
3988 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3989 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3990 yes | yes | yes | no
3991 Arguments : none
3992
3993 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3994 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3995 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3996 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3997
3998 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3999 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4000 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4001 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4002
4003 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4004 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4005 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4006 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4007 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4008
4009 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4010
4011 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4012 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4013 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
4014
4015 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4016 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4017
4018 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
4019
4020
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004021option contstats
4022 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
4023 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4024 yes | yes | yes | no
4025 Arguments : none
4026
4027 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
4028 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
4029 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
4030 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
4031 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
4032 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
4033 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
4034
4035
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004036option dontlog-normal
4037no option dontlog-normal
4038 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
4039 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4040 yes | yes | yes | no
4041 Arguments : none
4042
4043 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
4044 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
4045 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
4046 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
4047 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
4048 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
4049 logged.
4050
4051 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
4052 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
4053 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
4054
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004055 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004056 logging.
4057
4058
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004059option dontlognull
4060no option dontlognull
4061 Enable or disable logging of null connections
4062 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4063 yes | yes | yes | no
4064 Arguments : none
4065
4066 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
4067 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
4068 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
4069 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
4070 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
4071 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
4072 which typically corresponds to those probes.
4073
4074 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
4075 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
4076 would not be logged.
4077
4078 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4079 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4080
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004081 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004082
4083
4084option forceclose
4085no option forceclose
4086 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
4087 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01004088 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004089 Arguments : none
4090
4091 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
4092 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
4093 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
4094 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
4095 global session times in the logs.
4096
4097 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01004098 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004099 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004100
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004101 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
4102 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
4103 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
4104
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004105 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4106 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004107
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004108 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4109 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4110
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004111 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004112
4113
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004114option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004115 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
4116 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4117 yes | yes | yes | yes
4118 Arguments :
4119 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4120 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004121 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004122 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004123
4124 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
4125 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
4126 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
4127 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
4128 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
4129 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
4130 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004131 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
4132 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4133 possible that the client has already brought one.
4134
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004135 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004136 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004137 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
4138 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004139 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
4140 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004141
4142 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4143 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4144 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4145 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4146 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4147 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4148 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4149
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004150 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
4151 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
4152 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
4153 are under the control of the end-user.
4154
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004155 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004156 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4157 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004158 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
4159 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
4160 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004161
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004162 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004163 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
4164 frontend www
4165 mode http
4166 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
4167
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004168 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
4169 backend www
4170 mode http
4171 option forwardfor header X-Client
4172
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004173 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004174 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004175
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004176
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004177option http-keep-alive
4178no option http-keep-alive
4179 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
4180 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4181 yes | yes | yes | yes
4182 Arguments : none
4183
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004184 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4185 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4186 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
4187 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
4188 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4189 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
4190 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
4191
4192 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
4193 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004194 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
4195 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
4196 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
4197 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
4198 situations where this option may be useful :
4199
4200 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
4201 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
4202
4203 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
4204 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
4205
4206 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
4207 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
4208 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
4209 request.
4210
4211 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
4212 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004213 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
4214 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
4215 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004216
4217 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
4218 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
4219
4220 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4221 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4222 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4223 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
4224 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4225 not set.
4226
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004227 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4228 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004229 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004230 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004231
4232 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004233 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
4234 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004235
4236
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004237option http-no-delay
4238no option http-no-delay
4239 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
4240 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4241 yes | yes | yes | yes
4242 Arguments : none
4243
4244 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
4245 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
4246 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
4247 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
4248 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
4249 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
4250 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
4251 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
4252 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
4253 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
4254 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
4255 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
4256 affected.
4257
4258 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
4259 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
4260 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
4261 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
4262 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
4263 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
4264 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
4265 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
4266 latency environments.
4267
4268
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004269option http-pretend-keepalive
4270no option http-pretend-keepalive
4271 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
4272 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4273 yes | yes | yes | yes
4274 Arguments : none
4275
4276 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
4277 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
4278 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
4279 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
4280 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
4281 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
4282 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
4283 consider the response complete.
4284
4285 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
4286 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
4287 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
4288 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
4289 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
4290 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
4291
4292 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
4293 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
4294 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
4295 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
4296 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
4297 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
4298 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
4299
4300 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4301 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004302 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02004303 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
4304 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004305
4306 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4307 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4308
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004309 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
4310 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004311
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004312
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004313option http-server-close
4314no option http-server-close
4315 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
4316 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4317 yes | yes | yes | yes
4318 Arguments : none
4319
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004320 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4321 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4322 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4323 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4324 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4325 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
4326 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
4327 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
4328 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
4329 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
4330 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
4331 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
4332 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
4333 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
4334 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
4335 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004336
4337 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4338 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4339 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4340 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01004341 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4342 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004343
4344 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4345 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004346 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
4347 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004348 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
4349 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004350
4351 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4352 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4353
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004354 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004355 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4356 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004357
4358
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004359option http-tunnel
4360no option http-tunnel
4361 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
4362 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4363 yes | yes | yes | yes
4364 Arguments : none
4365
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004366 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4367 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4368 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4369 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4370 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4371 "option http-tunnel".
4372
4373 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004374 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004375 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
4376 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
4377 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
4378 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
4379 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
4380 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
4381 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004382
4383 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4384 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4385
4386 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
4387 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4388 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
4389
4390
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004391option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004392no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004393 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
4394 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4395 yes | yes | yes | no
4396 Arguments : none
4397
4398 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
4399 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
4400 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
4401 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
4402 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
4403 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
4404 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
4405
4406 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
4407 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
4408 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
4409 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
4410 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
4411 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
4412 request along its whole life.
4413
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01004414 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
4415 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
4416 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
4417 front of an existing proxy.
4418
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004419 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
4420
4421 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
4422 http-server-close".
4423
4424
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004425option httpchk
4426option httpchk <uri>
4427option httpchk <method> <uri>
4428option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
4429 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
4430 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4431 yes | no | yes | yes
4432 Arguments :
4433 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
4434 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
4435 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
4436 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
4437 ones.
4438
4439 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
4440 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
4441 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
4442
4443 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
4444 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
4445 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
4446 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
4447 after "\r\n" following the version string.
4448
4449 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
4450 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
4451 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
4452 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
4453 the lack of any response.
4454
4455 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
4456
4457 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
4458 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
4459 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
4460
4461 Examples :
4462 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
4463 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
4464 backend https_relay
4465 mode tcp
4466 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
4467 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
4468
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09004469 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
4470 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
4471 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004472
4473
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004474option httpclose
4475no option httpclose
4476 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
4477 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4478 yes | yes | yes | yes
4479 Arguments : none
4480
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004481 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4482 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4483 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4484 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004485 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004486 "option http-tunnel".
4487
4488 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
4489 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
4490 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
4491 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
4492 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
4493 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
4494 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
4495 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004496
4497 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004498 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01004499 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
4500 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
4501 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
4502 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
4503 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004504
4505 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4506 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004507 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
4508 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004509 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
4510 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004511
4512 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4513 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4514
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004515 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
4516 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004517
4518
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004519option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004520 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
4521 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4522 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004523 Arguments :
4524 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
4525 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
4526 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
4527 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
4528 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004529
4530 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4531 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4532 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
4533 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
4534 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
4535 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
4536 ports.
4537
4538 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4539
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01004540 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
4541 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004542
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004543 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004544
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004545
4546option http_proxy
4547no option http_proxy
4548 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
4549 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4550 yes | yes | yes | yes
4551 Arguments : none
4552
4553 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
4554 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
4555 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
4556 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
4557 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
4558
4559 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
4560 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
4561 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
4562 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01004563 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004564 be analyzed.
4565
4566 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4567 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4568
4569 Example :
4570 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
4571 backend direct_forward
4572 option httpclose
4573 option http_proxy
4574
4575 See also : "option httpclose"
4576
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004577
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004578option independent-streams
4579no option independent-streams
4580 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004581 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4582 yes | yes | yes | yes
4583 Arguments : none
4584
4585 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
4586 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
4587 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
4588 receive data or not.
4589
4590 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
4591 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
4592 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
4593 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
4594 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
4595 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
4596 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
4597 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
4598 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
4599 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
4600 socket buffers.
4601
4602 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
4603 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
4604 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
4605 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
4606 slow lines, so use it with caution.
4607
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004608 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004609 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
4610 deprecated.
4611
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004612 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004613
4614
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004615option ldap-check
4616 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
4617 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4618 yes | no | yes | yes
4619 Arguments : none
4620
4621 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
4622 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
4623 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
4624 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
4625
4626 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
4627 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
4628
4629 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
4630 configure it.
4631
4632 Example :
4633 option ldap-check
4634
4635 See also : "option httpchk"
4636
4637
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09004638option external-check
4639 Use external processes for server health checks
4640 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4641 yes | no | yes | yes
4642
4643 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
4644 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
4645 command".
4646
4647 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
4648
4649 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
4650
4651
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004652option log-health-checks
4653no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004654 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004655 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4656 yes | no | yes | yes
4657 Arguments : none
4658
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004659 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
4660 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
4661 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004662
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004663 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
4664 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
4665 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
4666 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
4667 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
4668
4669 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
4670 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004671
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004672 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
4673 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
4674 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004675
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004676
4677option log-separate-errors
4678no option log-separate-errors
4679 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
4680 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4681 yes | yes | yes | no
4682 Arguments : none
4683
4684 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
4685 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
4686 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
4687 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
4688 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
4689 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
4690 provides very important information.
4691
4692 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
4693 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
4694 error logs.
4695
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004696 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004697 logging.
4698
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004699
4700option logasap
4701no option logasap
4702 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
4703 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4704 yes | yes | yes | no
4705 Arguments : none
4706
4707 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
4708 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
4709 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
4710 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
4711 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
4712 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
4713 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004714 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004715 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
4716 bytes are expected to be transferred.
4717
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004718 Examples :
4719 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
4720 mode http
4721 option httplog
4722 option logasap
4723 log 192.168.2.200 local3
4724
4725 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
4726 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
4727 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
4728 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
4729
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004730 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004731 logging.
4732
4733
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02004734option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004735 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004736 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4737 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004738 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004739 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
4740 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02004741 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004742
4743 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
4744 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
4745 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
4746 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
4747 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
4748 in the MySQL table, like this :
4749
4750 USE mysql;
4751 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
4752 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
4753
4754 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
4755 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
4756 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
4757 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
4758 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
4759 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
4760 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
4761 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
4762 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
4763
4764 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
4765 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004766
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02004767 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004768
4769 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
4770 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
4771 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4772 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4773 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
4774 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
4775
4776 See also: "option httpchk"
4777
4778
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004779option nolinger
4780no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004781 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004782 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4783 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004784 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004785
4786 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
4787 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
4788 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
4789 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
4790 connections.
4791
4792 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
4793 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
4794 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
4795 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
4796 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
4797 this too.
4798
4799 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
4800 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
4801 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
4802
4803 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
4804 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
4805 for servers.
4806
4807 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4808 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4809
4810
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004811option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
4812 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
4813 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4814 yes | yes | yes | yes
4815 Arguments :
4816 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4817 matching <network>
4818 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
4819 header name.
4820
4821 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
4822 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
4823 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
4824 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
4825 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
4826 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
4827 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
4828 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
4829 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4830 possible that the client has already brought one.
4831
4832 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
4833 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
4834 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
4835 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
4836 header and requires different one.
4837
4838 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4839 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4840 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4841 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4842 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4843 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4844 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4845
4846 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
4847 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4848 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
4849 both are defined.
4850
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004851 Examples :
4852 # Original Destination address
4853 frontend www
4854 mode http
4855 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
4856
4857 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
4858 backend www
4859 mode http
4860 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
4861
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004862 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
4863 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004864
4865
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004866option persist
4867no option persist
4868 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
4869 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4870 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004871 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004872
4873 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
4874 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
4875 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
4876 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
4877 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
4878 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
4879 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
4880 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
4881 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
4882 redirected to another valid server.
4883
4884 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4885 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4886
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004887 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004888
4889
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01004890option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
4891 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
4892 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4893 yes | no | yes | yes
4894 Arguments :
4895 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
4896 PostgreSQL server.
4897
4898 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
4899 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
4900 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
4901 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
4902
4903 See also: "option httpchk"
4904
4905
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004906option prefer-last-server
4907no option prefer-last-server
4908 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
4909 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4910 yes | no | yes | yes
4911 Arguments : none
4912
4913 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
4914 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
4915 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
4916 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
4917 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
4918 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
4919 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
4920 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
4921 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01004922 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
4923 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
4924 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
4925 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
4926 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
4927 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
4928 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004929
4930 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4931 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4932
4933 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
4934
4935
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004936option redispatch
4937no option redispatch
4938 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4939 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4940 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004941 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004942
4943 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4944 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4945 be able to access the service anymore.
4946
4947 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
4948 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
4949
4950 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4951 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4952 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004953
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004954 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
4955 "redisp" keywords.
4956
4957 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4958 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4959
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004960 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004961
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004962
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004963option redis-check
4964 Use redis health checks for server testing
4965 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4966 yes | no | yes | yes
4967 Arguments : none
4968
4969 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
4970 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
4971 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
4972 find the "+PONG" response message.
4973
4974 Example :
4975 option redis-check
4976
4977 See also : "option httpchk"
4978
4979
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004980option smtpchk
4981option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
4982 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
4983 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4984 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004985 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004986 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
4987 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
4988 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
4989
4990 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
4991 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
4992 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
4993
4994 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
4995 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
4996 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
4997 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
4998 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
4999 dead server.
5000
5001 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
5002 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
5003 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
5004 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
5005
5006 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
5007 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
5008 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
5009 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
5010 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
5011
5012 Example :
5013 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
5014
5015 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
5016
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005017
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02005018option socket-stats
5019no option socket-stats
5020
5021 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
5022 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5023 yes | yes | yes | no
5024
5025 Arguments : none
5026
5027
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005028option splice-auto
5029no option splice-auto
5030 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
5031 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5032 yes | yes | yes | yes
5033 Arguments : none
5034
5035 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
5036 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
5037 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
5038 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005039 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005040 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
5041 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
5042 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
5043 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5044
5045 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
5046 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
5047 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
5048 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
5049 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
5050 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
5051 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
5052 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
5053 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
5054 keyword.
5055
5056 Example :
5057 option splice-auto
5058
5059 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5060 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5061
5062 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
5063 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5064
5065
5066option splice-request
5067no option splice-request
5068 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
5069 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5070 yes | yes | yes | yes
5071 Arguments : none
5072
5073 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005074 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005075 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
5076 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
5077 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
5078 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5079
5080 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
5081
5082 Example :
5083 option splice-request
5084
5085 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5086 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5087
5088 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
5089 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5090
5091
5092option splice-response
5093no option splice-response
5094 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
5095 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5096 yes | yes | yes | yes
5097 Arguments : none
5098
5099 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005100 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005101 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
5102 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
5103 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
5104 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5105
5106 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
5107
5108 Example :
5109 option splice-response
5110
5111 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5112 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5113
5114 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
5115 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5116
5117
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005118option srvtcpka
5119no option srvtcpka
5120 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
5121 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5122 yes | no | yes | yes
5123 Arguments : none
5124
5125 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5126 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5127 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5128 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5129
5130 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5131 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5132 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5133 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5134
5135 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5136 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5137 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5138 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5139 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5140
5141 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5142
5143 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5144 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5145 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
5146
5147 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5148 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5149
5150 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
5151
5152
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005153option ssl-hello-chk
5154 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
5155 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5156 yes | no | yes | yes
5157 Arguments : none
5158
5159 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
5160 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
5161 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
5162 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
5163 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
5164 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
5165 hello message.
5166
5167 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
5168 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
5169 messages, which is appreciable.
5170
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005171 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
5172 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
5173 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005174
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005175 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
5176
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005177
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005178option tcp-check
5179 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
5180 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5181 yes | no | yes | yes
5182
5183 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
5184 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
5185
5186 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
5187 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
5188 attempt, which remains the default mode.
5189
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005190 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005191 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
5192 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
5193 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
5194 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
5195 only.
5196
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005197 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005198 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
5199 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
5200 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
5201 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
5202
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005203 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005204 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
5205 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005206 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005207 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
5208 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
5209 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
5210 the respective protocols.
5211 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
5212 analysed.
5213
5214 Examples :
5215 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
5216 option tcp-check
5217 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
5218
5219 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
5220 option tcp-check
5221 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
5222
5223 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
5224 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005225 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005226 option tcp-check
5227 tcp-check send PING\r\n
5228 tcp-check expect +PONG
5229 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
5230 tcp-check expect string role:master
5231 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
5232 tcp-check expect string +OK
5233
5234 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
5235 (send many headers before analyzing)
5236 option tcp-check
5237 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
5238 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
5239 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
5240 tcp-check send \r\n
5241 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..)
5242
5243
5244 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
5245
5246
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005247option tcp-smart-accept
5248no option tcp-smart-accept
5249 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
5250 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5251 yes | yes | yes | no
5252 Arguments : none
5253
5254 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
5255 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
5256 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
5257 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
5258 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
5259 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
5260
5261 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
5262 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
5263 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
5264 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
5265
5266 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
5267 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
5268 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
5269 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
5270
5271 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
5272 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
5273 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
5274
5275 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
5276 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
5277 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
5278
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02005279 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
5280
5281
5282option tcp-smart-connect
5283no option tcp-smart-connect
5284 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
5285 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5286 yes | no | yes | yes
5287 Arguments : none
5288
5289 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
5290 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
5291 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
5292 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
5293 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
5294
5295 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
5296 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
5297 complex.
5298
5299 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
5300 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
5301 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
5302
5303 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5304 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5305
5306 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
5307
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005308
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005309option tcpka
5310 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
5311 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5312 yes | yes | yes | yes
5313 Arguments : none
5314
5315 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5316 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5317 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5318 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5319
5320 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5321 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5322 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5323 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5324
5325 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5326 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5327 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5328 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5329 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5330
5331 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5332
5333 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
5334 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
5335 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
5336 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
5337 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
5338 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
5339 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
5340 backends.
5341
5342 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
5343
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005344
5345option tcplog
5346 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
5347 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5348 yes | yes | yes | yes
5349 Arguments : none
5350
5351 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5352 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5353 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
5354 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
5355 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
5356 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
5357 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
5358 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
5359
5360 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5361
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005362 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005363
5364
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005365option transparent
5366no option transparent
5367 Enable client-side transparent proxying
5368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01005369 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005370 Arguments : none
5371
5372 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
5373 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
5374 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
5375 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
5376 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
5377 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
5378 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
5379 appropriate server.
5380
5381 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
5382 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
5383
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01005384 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005385 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005386
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005387
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005388external-check command <command>
5389 Executable to run when performing an external-check
5390 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5391 yes | no | yes | yes
5392
5393 Arguments :
5394 <command> is the external command to run
5395
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005396 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
5397
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01005398 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005399
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01005400 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
5401 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
5402 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
5403 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
5404 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
5405 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005406
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01005407 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
5408
5409 Environment variables :
5410 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
5411 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
5412
5413 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
5414
5415 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
5416
5417 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
5418 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
5419 for a UNIX socket).
5420
5421 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
5422
5423 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
5424
5425 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
5426
5427 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
5428
5429 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
5430
5431 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
5432 socket).
5433
5434 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
5435 the command may be set using "external-check path".
5436
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005437 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
5438 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
5439 failed.
5440
5441 Example :
5442 external-check command /bin/true
5443
5444 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
5445
5446
5447external-check path <path>
5448 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
5449 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5450 yes | no | yes | yes
5451
5452 Arguments :
5453 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
5454
5455 The default path is "".
5456
5457 Example :
5458 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
5459
5460 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
5461 "external-check command"
5462
5463
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005464persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02005465persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005466 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
5467 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5468 yes | no | yes | yes
5469 Arguments :
5470 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005471 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
5472 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005473
5474 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
5475 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
5476 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
5477 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
5478 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
5479 forwarded to this server.
5480
5481 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
5482 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
5483 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005484 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005485 a single "listen" section.
5486
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005487 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
5488 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
5489 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
5490
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005491 Example :
5492 listen tse-farm
5493 bind :3389
5494 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
5495 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5496 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
5497 # apply RDP cookie persistence
5498 persist rdp-cookie
5499 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005500 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005501 balance rdp-cookie
5502 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
5503 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
5504
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09005505 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
5506 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005507
5508
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005509rate-limit sessions <rate>
5510 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
5511 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5512 yes | yes | yes | no
5513 Arguments :
5514 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
5515 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
5516
5517 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
5518 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
5519 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
5520 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
5521 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
5522 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
5523
5524 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
5525 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
5526 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
5527 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
5528
5529 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
5530 listen smtp
5531 mode tcp
5532 bind :25
5533 rate-limit sessions 10
5534 server 127.0.0.1:1025
5535
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02005536 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
5537 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
5538 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005539
5540 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
5541
5542
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005543redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5544redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5545redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005546 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
5547 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5548 no | yes | yes | yes
5549
5550 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01005551 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005552
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005553 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005554 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005555 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
5556 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
5557 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005558
5559 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
5560 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
5561 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
5562 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
5563 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005564 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
5565 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
5566 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
5567 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005568
5569 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
5570 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
5571 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
5572 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
5573 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
5574 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005575 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005576 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005577 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
5578 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
5579 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005580
5581 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01005582 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
5583 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
5584 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
5585 means "Moved permanently" and means that the browser should not
5586 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
5587 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
5588 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
5589 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005590
5591 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
5592 expected behaviour of a redirection :
5593
5594 - "drop-query"
5595 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
5596 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
5597 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
5598 with a location-type redirect.
5599
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005600 - "append-slash"
5601 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
5602 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
5603 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
5604 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
5605
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005606 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
5607 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
5608 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
5609 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
5610 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
5611 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
5612 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
5613
5614 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
5615 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
5616 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
5617 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
5618 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
5619 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
5620 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005621
5622 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
5623 acl clear dst_port 80
5624 acl secure dst_port 8080
5625 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005626 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005627 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005628 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
5629
5630 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005631 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
5632 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
5633 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005634 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005635
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005636 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
5637 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
5638 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
5639
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005640 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01005641 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005642
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005643 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
5644 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
5645 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
5646
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005647 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005648
5649
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005650redisp (deprecated)
5651redispatch (deprecated)
5652 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5653 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5654 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005655 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005656
5657 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5658 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5659 be able to access the service anymore.
5660
5661 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
5662 redistribute them to a working server.
5663
5664 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
5665 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5666 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005667
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005668 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
5669 "option redispatch" instead.
5670
5671 See also : "option redispatch"
5672
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005673
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005674reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005675 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
5676 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5677 no | yes | yes | yes
5678 Arguments :
5679 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5680 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005681 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005682
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005683 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5684 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5685
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005686 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5687 the last header of an HTTP request.
5688
5689 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5690 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5691 responses.
5692
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005693 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
5694 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
5695 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
5696
5697 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5698 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005699
5700
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005701reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5702reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005703 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5704 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5705 no | yes | yes | yes
5706 Arguments :
5707 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5708 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5709 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5710 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5711 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5712 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
5713 ignores case.
5714
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005715 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5716 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5717
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005718 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5719 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
5720 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5721 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005722 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005723
5724 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5725 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5726
5727 Example :
5728 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
5729 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5730 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5731
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005732 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
5733 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005734
5735
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005736reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5737reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005738 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
5739 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5740 no | yes | yes | yes
5741 Arguments :
5742 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5743 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5744 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5745 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5746 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
5747 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
5748
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005749 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5750 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5751
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005752 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
5753 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
5754 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
5755 next servers.
5756
5757 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5758 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5759 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5760
5761 Example :
5762 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
5763 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
5764 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
5765
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005766 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5767 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005768
5769
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005770reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5771reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005772 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5773 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5774 no | yes | yes | yes
5775 Arguments :
5776 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5777 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5778 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5779 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5780 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5781 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
5782 case.
5783
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005784 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5785 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5786
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005787 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5788 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
5789 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5790 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005791 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005792
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005793 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005794 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005795 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005796
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005797 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5798 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5799
5800 Example :
5801 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
5802 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5803 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5804
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005805 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5806 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005807
5808
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005809reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5810reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005811 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
5812 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5813 no | yes | yes | yes
5814 Arguments :
5815 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5816 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5817 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5818 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5819 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5820 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
5821 case.
5822
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005823 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5824 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5825
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005826 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5827 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
5828 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
5829 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5830
5831 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5832 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5833
5834 Example :
5835 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
5836 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
5837 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5838 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5839
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005840 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5841 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005842
5843
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005844reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5845reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005846 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
5847 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5848 no | yes | yes | yes
5849 Arguments :
5850 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5851 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5852 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5853 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5854 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
5855 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
5856
5857 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5858 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5859 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5860 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005861 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005862
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005863 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5864 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5865
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005866 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
5867 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
5868 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
5869
5870 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5871 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5872 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5873 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
5874 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5875
5876 Example :
5877 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005878 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005879 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
5880 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
5881
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04005882 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
5883 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005884
5885
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005886reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5887reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005888 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
5889 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5890 no | yes | yes | yes
5891 Arguments :
5892 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5893 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5894 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5895 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5896 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5897 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
5898 ignores case.
5899
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005900 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5901 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5902
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005903 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5904 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005905 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
5906 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
5907 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005908 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
5909 not set.
5910
5911 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
5912 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
5913 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
5914 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
5915 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
5916
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005917 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005918 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
5919 # block all others.
5920 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
5921 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
5922
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005923 # block bad guys
5924 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
5925 reqitarpit . if badguys
5926
5927 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
5928 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005929
5930
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02005931retries <value>
5932 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
5933 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5934 yes | no | yes | yes
5935 Arguments :
5936 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
5937 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
5938 default value is 3.
5939
5940 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
5941 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
5942 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
5943
5944 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
5945 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
5946
5947 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
5948 server even if a cookie references a different server.
5949
5950 See also : "option redispatch"
5951
5952
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005953rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005954 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
5955 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5956 no | yes | yes | yes
5957 Arguments :
5958 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5959 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005960 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005961
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005962 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5963 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5964
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005965 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5966 the last header of an HTTP response.
5967
5968 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5969 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5970 responses.
5971
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005972 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5973 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005974
5975
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005976rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5977rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005978 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
5979 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5980 no | yes | yes | yes
5981 Arguments :
5982 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5983 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5984 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5985 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5986 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5987 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
5988 ignores case.
5989
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005990 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5991 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5992
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005993 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
5994 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005995 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005996 client.
5997
5998 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5999 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6000 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
6001
6002 Example :
6003 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02006004 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006005
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006006 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
6007 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006008
6009
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006010rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6011rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006012 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
6013 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6014 no | yes | yes | yes
6015 Arguments :
6016 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6017 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6018 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6019 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6020 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6021 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
6022 ignores case.
6023
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006024 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6025 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6026
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006027 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6028 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
6029 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
6030 case-sensitive.
6031
6032 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006033 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
6034 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
6035 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006036
6037 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6038 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
6039
6040 Example :
6041 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
6042 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
6043
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006044 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
6045 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006046
6047
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006048rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6049rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006050 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
6051 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6052 no | yes | yes | yes
6053 Arguments :
6054 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6055 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6056 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6057 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6058 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6059 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
6060 ignores case.
6061
6062 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6063 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
6064 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
6065 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006066 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006067
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006068 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6069 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6070
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006071 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
6072 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
6073 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
6074
6075 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6076 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6077 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
6078 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
6079 are not case-sensitive.
6080
6081 Example :
6082 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
6083 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
6084
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006085 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
6086 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006087
6088
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01006089server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006090 Declare a server in a backend
6091 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6092 no | no | yes | yes
6093 Arguments :
6094 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02006095 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006096 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006097
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01006098 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
6099 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
6100 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
6101 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02006102 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
6103 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
6104 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
6105 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
6106 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006107 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
6108 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
6109 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
6110 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
6111 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
6112 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
6113 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02006114 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006115 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
6116 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
6117 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
6118 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006119
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006120 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006121 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
6122 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
6123 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
6124 adding this value to the client's port.
6125
6126 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
6127 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006128 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006129
6130 Examples :
6131 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
6132 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006133 server transp ipv4@
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006134 server backup ${SRV_BACKUP}:1080 backup
6135 server www1_dc1 ${LAN_DC1}.101:80
6136 server www1_dc2 ${LAN_DC2}.101:80
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006137
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006138 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
6139 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006140
6141
6142source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006143source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01006144source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006145 Set the source address for outgoing connections
6146 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6147 yes | no | yes | yes
6148 Arguments :
6149 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
6150 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006151
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006152 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006153 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
6154 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
6155 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
6156 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
6157 supported prefixes are :
6158 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
6159 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
6160 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02006161 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006162 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
6163 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
6164 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
6165 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006166
6167 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
6168 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006169 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
6170 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
6171 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006172
6173 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
6174 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
6175 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
6176 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
6177 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
6178 <addr>.
6179
6180 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
6181 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
6182 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
6183 port.
6184
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006185 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
6186 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
6187 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
6188 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01006189 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006190 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
6191 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
6192 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
6193 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
6194 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
6195 HTTP header.
6196
6197 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
6198 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006199 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006200 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
6201 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
6202 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
6203 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
6204 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
6205 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
6206 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
6207
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01006208 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
6209 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
6210 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
6211 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
6212 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
6213 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
6214
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006215 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
6216 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
6217 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
6218 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
6219
6220 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
6221 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
6222 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
6223 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
6224 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
6225 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
6226
6227 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
6228 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
6229 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
6230 there are two methods :
6231
6232 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
6233 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
6234 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
6235 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
6236 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
6237 of the client ranges may be used.
6238
6239 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
6240 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
6241 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
6242 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
6243 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
6244 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
6245 same session.
6246
6247 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
6248 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
6249 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
6250 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
6251 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
6252 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
6253
6254 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
6255 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
6256 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006257 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006258
6259 Examples :
6260 backend private
6261 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
6262 source 192.168.1.200
6263
6264 backend transparent_ssl1
6265 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
6266 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6267
6268 backend transparent_ssl2
6269 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
6270 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
6271 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
6272
6273 backend transparent_ssl3
6274 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
6275 # is more conntrack-friendly.
6276 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6277
6278 backend transparent_smtp
6279 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
6280 # with Tproxy version 4.
6281 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
6282
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006283 backend transparent_http
6284 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
6285 # proxy.
6286 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
6287
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006288 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006289 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
6290
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006291
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006292srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6293 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6294 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6295 yes | no | yes | yes
6296 Arguments :
6297 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6298 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6299 as explained at the top of this document.
6300
6301 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6302 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6303 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6304 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6305 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6306 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6307 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6308
6309 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6310 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6311 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6312 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6313 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006314 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006315 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006316 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006317
6318 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6319 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6320 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6321 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6322 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6323 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6324
6325 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
6326 Please use "timeout server" instead.
6327
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006328 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
6329 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006330
6331
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006332stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
6333 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
6334 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006335 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006336
6337 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
6338 matched.
6339
6340 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
6341 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
6342
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006343 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6344 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6345 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6346
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01006347 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
6348 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
6349 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
6350 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006351
6352 Example :
6353 # statistics admin level only for localhost
6354 backend stats_localhost
6355 stats enable
6356 stats admin if LOCALHOST
6357
6358 Example :
6359 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
6360 backend stats_auth
6361 stats enable
6362 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
6363 stats admin if TRUE
6364
6365 Example :
6366 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
6367 userlist stats-auth
6368 group admin users admin
6369 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
6370 group readonly users haproxy
6371 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
6372
6373 backend stats_auth
6374 stats enable
6375 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
6376 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
6377 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
6378 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
6379
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006380 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
6381 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6382 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006383
6384
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006385stats auth <user>:<passwd>
6386 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
6387 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006388 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006389 Arguments :
6390 <user> is a user name to grant access to
6391
6392 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
6393
6394 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
6395 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
6396 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
6397 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
6398 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
6399 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
6400
6401 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
6402 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
6403 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006404 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006405
6406 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
6407 report using "stats scope".
6408
6409 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6410 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6411 unobvious parameters.
6412
6413 Example :
6414 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6415 backend public_www
6416 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6417 stats enable
6418 stats hide-version
6419 stats scope .
6420 stats uri /admin?stats
6421 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6422 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6423 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6424
6425 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6426 backend private_monitoring
6427 stats enable
6428 stats uri /admin?stats
6429 stats refresh 5s
6430
6431 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
6432
6433
6434stats enable
6435 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
6436 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006437 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006438 Arguments : none
6439
6440 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
6441 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
6442 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
6443 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
6444 - stats auth : no authentication
6445 - stats scope : no restriction
6446
6447 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6448 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6449 unobvious parameters.
6450
6451 Example :
6452 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6453 backend public_www
6454 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6455 stats enable
6456 stats hide-version
6457 stats scope .
6458 stats uri /admin?stats
6459 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6460 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6461 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6462
6463 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6464 backend private_monitoring
6465 stats enable
6466 stats uri /admin?stats
6467 stats refresh 5s
6468
6469 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6470
6471
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006472stats hide-version
6473 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006474 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006475 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006476 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006477
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006478 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
6479 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
6480 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
6481 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
6482 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
6483 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006484
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006485 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6486 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6487 unobvious parameters.
6488
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006489 Example :
6490 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6491 backend public_www
6492 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006493 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006494 stats hide-version
6495 stats scope .
6496 stats uri /admin?stats
6497 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6498 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6499 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006500
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006501 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6502 backend private_monitoring
6503 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006504 stats uri /admin?stats
6505 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01006506
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006507 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006508
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006509
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02006510stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
6511 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6512 Access control for statistics
6513
6514 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6515 no | no | yes | yes
6516
6517 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
6518 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
6519 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
6520 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
6521 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
6522 should be asked to enter a username and password.
6523
6524 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
6525 instance.
6526
6527 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6528 about ACL usage.
6529
6530
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006531stats realm <realm>
6532 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
6533 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006534 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006535 Arguments :
6536 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
6537 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
6538 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
6539
6540 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
6541 using a backslash ('\').
6542
6543 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
6544 only related to authentication.
6545
6546 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6547 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6548 unobvious parameters.
6549
6550 Example :
6551 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6552 backend public_www
6553 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6554 stats enable
6555 stats hide-version
6556 stats scope .
6557 stats uri /admin?stats
6558 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6559 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6560 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6561
6562 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6563 backend private_monitoring
6564 stats enable
6565 stats uri /admin?stats
6566 stats refresh 5s
6567
6568 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
6569
6570
6571stats refresh <delay>
6572 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
6573 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006574 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006575 Arguments :
6576 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
6577 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
6578 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
6579 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
6580 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
6581 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
6582
6583 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
6584 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
6585 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
6586 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
6587
6588 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6589 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6590 unobvious parameters.
6591
6592 Example :
6593 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6594 backend public_www
6595 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6596 stats enable
6597 stats hide-version
6598 stats scope .
6599 stats uri /admin?stats
6600 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6601 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6602 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6603
6604 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6605 backend private_monitoring
6606 stats enable
6607 stats uri /admin?stats
6608 stats refresh 5s
6609
6610 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6611
6612
6613stats scope { <name> | "." }
6614 Enable statistics and limit access scope
6615 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006616 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006617 Arguments :
6618 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
6619 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
6620 section in which the statement appears.
6621
6622 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
6623 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
6624 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
6625 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
6626 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
6627 exists.
6628
6629 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6630 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6631 unobvious parameters.
6632
6633 Example :
6634 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6635 backend public_www
6636 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6637 stats enable
6638 stats hide-version
6639 stats scope .
6640 stats uri /admin?stats
6641 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6642 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6643 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6644
6645 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6646 backend private_monitoring
6647 stats enable
6648 stats uri /admin?stats
6649 stats refresh 5s
6650
6651 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6652
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006653
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006654stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006655 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
6656 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006657 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006658
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006659 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006660 description from global section is automatically used instead.
6661
6662 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6663 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
6664
6665 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6666 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006667 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006668
6669 Example :
6670 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6671 backend private_monitoring
6672 stats enable
6673 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
6674 stats uri /admin?stats
6675 stats refresh 5s
6676
6677 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
6678 global section.
6679
6680
6681stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006682 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
6683 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6684 yes | yes | yes | yes
6685 Arguments : none
6686
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006687 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006688 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
6689 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
6690 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
6691 - IP (socket, server)
6692 - cookie (backend, server)
6693
6694 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6695 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006696 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006697
6698 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
6699
6700
6701stats show-node [ <name> ]
6702 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
6703 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006704 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006705 Arguments:
6706 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
6707 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
6708
6709 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6710 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006711 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006712
6713 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6714 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6715 unobvious parameters.
6716
6717 Example:
6718 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6719 backend private_monitoring
6720 stats enable
6721 stats show-node Europe-1
6722 stats uri /admin?stats
6723 stats refresh 5s
6724
6725 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
6726 section.
6727
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006728
6729stats uri <prefix>
6730 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
6731 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006732 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006733 Arguments :
6734 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
6735 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
6736 query string.
6737
6738 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
6739 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
6740 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
6741 possible to reach it in the application.
6742
6743 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006744 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006745 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
6746 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
6747 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
6748 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
6749
6750 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
6751 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
6752 an address or a port to statistics only.
6753
6754 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6755 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6756 unobvious parameters.
6757
6758 Example :
6759 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6760 backend public_www
6761 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6762 stats enable
6763 stats hide-version
6764 stats scope .
6765 stats uri /admin?stats
6766 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6767 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6768 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6769
6770 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6771 backend private_monitoring
6772 stats enable
6773 stats uri /admin?stats
6774 stats refresh 5s
6775
6776 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
6777
6778
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006779stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
6780 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006781 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006782 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006783
6784 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006785 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006786 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6787 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
6788 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
6789
6790 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6791 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6792 the "stick-table" statement.
6793
6794 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
6795 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
6796 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
6797 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
6798 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
6799
6800 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6801 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
6802 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
6803 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
6804 transformation rules.
6805
6806 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6807 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6808 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6809 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6810 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6811 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6812 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6813
6814 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
6815 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
6816 ACL based conditions.
6817
6818 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
6819 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
6820 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
6821 matches can be used as fallbacks.
6822
6823 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
6824 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
6825 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
6826 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
6827
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006828 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6829 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6830 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6831
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006832 Example :
6833 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6834 # last 30 minutes
6835 backend pop
6836 mode tcp
6837 balance roundrobin
6838 stick store-request src
6839 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6840 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6841 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6842
6843 backend smtp
6844 mode tcp
6845 balance roundrobin
6846 stick match src table pop
6847 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6848 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6849
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006850 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006851 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006852
6853
6854stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6855 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
6856 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6857 no | no | yes | yes
6858
6859 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
6860 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
6861 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
6862 for writing more maintainable configurations.
6863
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006864 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6865 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6866 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6867
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006868 Examples :
6869 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01006870 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006871
6872 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
6873 stick match src table pop if !localhost
6874 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
6875
6876
6877 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
6878 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
6879 backend http
6880 mode http
6881 balance roundrobin
6882 stick on src table https
6883 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
6884 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
6885 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
6886
6887 backend https
6888 mode tcp
6889 balance roundrobin
6890 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6891 stick on src
6892 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6893 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6894
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006895 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006896
6897
6898stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6899 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6900 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6901 no | no | yes | yes
6902
6903 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006904 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006905 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6906 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6907 server is selected.
6908
6909 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6910 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6911 the "stick-table" statement.
6912
6913 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6914 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6915 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
6916 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
6917 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
6918 address.
6919
6920 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6921 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
6922 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
6923 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
6924 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
6925 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
6926 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
6927 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
6928 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
6929 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
6930
6931 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6932 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6933 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6934 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6935 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6936 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6937 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6938
6939 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
6940 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6941 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
6942 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6943
6944 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
6945 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6946 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6947 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6948 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6949 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01006950 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
6951 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
6952 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
6953 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
6954 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
6955 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006956
6957 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
6958 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
6959 the request.
6960
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006961 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6962 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6963 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6964
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006965 Example :
6966 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6967 # last 30 minutes
6968 backend pop
6969 mode tcp
6970 balance roundrobin
6971 stick store-request src
6972 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6973 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6974 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6975
6976 backend smtp
6977 mode tcp
6978 balance roundrobin
6979 stick match src table pop
6980 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6981 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6982
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006983 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006984 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006985
6986
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006987stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006988 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
6989 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08006990 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006991 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006992 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006993
6994 Arguments :
6995 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
6996 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
6997 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6998 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6999
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01007000 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
7001 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
7002 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
7003 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
7004
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007005 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
7006 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
7007 instance.
7008
7009 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
7010 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
7011 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
7012 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
7013 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
7014 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007015 to 32 characters.
7016
7017 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
7018 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
7019 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007020 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007021 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
7022 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007023
7024 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007025 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
7026 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007027 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
7028 increase.
7029
7030 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007031 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
7032 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
7033 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007034
7035 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
7036 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
7037 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
7038 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
7039 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
7040 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
7041 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
7042 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
7043 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
7044 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
7045 parameter (see below).
7046
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02007047 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
7048 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
7049 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
7050 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
7051 soft restart.
7052
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007053 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
7054
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007055 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
7056 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
7057 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
7058 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
7059 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007060 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007061 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
7062 if not expiration delay is specified.
7063
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02007064 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
7065 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
7066 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
7067 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007068 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
7069 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
7070 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
7071 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
7072 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
7073 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
7074 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
7075 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
7076 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
7077 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
7078 types and their arguments.
7079
7080 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
7081 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
7082 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
7083 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
7084
7085 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
7086 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
7087 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
7088 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
7089
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02007090 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
7091 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
7092 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
7093 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
7094 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
7095 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
7096
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007097 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
7098 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
7099 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
7100 they were received.
7101
7102 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7103 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
7104 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
7105 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
7106 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
7107
7108 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7109 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7110 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7111 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
7112 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7113
7114 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
7115 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
7116 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
7117
7118 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7119 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7120 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7121 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
7122 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7123
7124 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7125 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
7126 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
7127 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
7128 the client side.
7129
7130 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7131 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7132 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7133 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
7134 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
7135 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
7136 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
7137
7138 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7139 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
7140 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
7141 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
7142 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
7143 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
7144 (eg: vulnerability scan).
7145
7146 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7147 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7148 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7149 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
7150 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
7151 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7152
7153 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
7154 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
7155 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
7156 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
7157
7158 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7159 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7160 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7161 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
7162 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
7163 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
7164 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
7165 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
7166 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
7167 recommended for better fairness.
7168
7169 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
7170 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
7171 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
7172 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
7173
7174 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
7175 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7176 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7177 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
7178 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
7179 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
7180 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
7181 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
7182 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
7183 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02007184
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02007185 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
7186 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007187 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
7188 reference it.
7189
7190 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
7191 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
7192 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
7193 as an exclusive stickiness.
7194
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007195 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
7196 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
7197 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
7198 something that can be ignored.
7199
7200 Example:
7201 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
7202 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
7203 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
7204 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
7205
7206 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01007207 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007208
7209
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007210stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7211 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
7212 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7213 no | no | yes | yes
7214
7215 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007216 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007217 describes what elements of the response or connection will
7218 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
7219 server is selected.
7220
7221 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7222 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7223 the "stick-table" statement.
7224
7225 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
7226 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
7227 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
7228 when the response is a SSL server hello.
7229
7230 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7231 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
7232 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
7233 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
7234 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
7235 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007236 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007237 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
7238 rules.
7239
7240 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7241 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7242 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7243 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7244 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7245 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7246 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7247
7248 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
7249 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
7250 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
7251 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
7252
7253 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
7254 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
7255 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
7256 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
7257 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
7258 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01007259 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
7260 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
7261 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
7262 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
7263 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
7264 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
7265 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
7266 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
7267 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007268
7269 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
7270
7271 Example :
7272 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
7273 backend https
7274 mode tcp
7275 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007276 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007277 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007278
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007279 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
7280 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
7281
7282 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
7283 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7284 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
7285
7286 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
7287 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007288
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007289 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
7290 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
7291 # at offset 44.
7292
7293 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
7294 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
7295
7296 # Learn on response if server hello.
7297 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007298
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007299 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
7300 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
7301
7302 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
7303 extraction.
7304
7305
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02007306tcp-check connect [params*]
7307 Opens a new connection
7308 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7309 no | no | yes | yes
7310
7311 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
7312 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
7313 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
7314
7315 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
7316 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
7317 of the sequence.
7318
7319 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
7320 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
7321 do.
7322
7323 Parameters :
7324 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
7325 use the TCP connection.
7326
7327 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
7328 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
7329 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
7330
7331 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
7332
7333 ssl opens a ciphered connection
7334
7335 Examples:
7336 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
7337 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
7338 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
7339 option tcp-check
7340 tcp-check connect
7341 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7342 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7343 tcp-check send \r\n
7344 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7345 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
7346 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7347 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7348 tcp-check send \r\n
7349 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7350 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
7351
7352 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
7353 option tcp-check
7354 tcp-check connect port 110
7355 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7356 tcp-check connect port 143
7357 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7358 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
7359
7360 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
7361
7362
7363tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
7364 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
7365 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7366 no | no | yes | yes
7367
7368 Arguments :
7369 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
7370 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
7371 binary.
7372 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
7373 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
7374 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
7375
7376 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
7377 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
7378 with the usual backslash ('\').
7379 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
7380 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
7381 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
7382 used upper or lower case.
7383
7384
7385 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
7386
7387 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
7388 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7389 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
7390 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7391 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
7392 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
7393 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
7394 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
7395
7396 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
7397 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7398 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
7399 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7400 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
7401 expression.
7402
7403 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
7404 in the response buffer. A health check response will
7405 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
7406 this exact hexadecimal string.
7407 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
7408
7409 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
7410 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
7411 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
7412 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
7413 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
7414 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
7415 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
7416 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
7417 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
7418 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
7419 the null character.
7420
7421 Examples :
7422 # perform a POP check
7423 option tcp-check
7424 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7425
7426 # perform an IMAP check
7427 option tcp-check
7428 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7429
7430 # look for the redis master server
7431 option tcp-check
7432 tcp-check send PING\r\n
7433 tcp-check expect +PONG
7434 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7435 tcp-check expect string role:master
7436 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7437 tcp-check expect string +OK
7438
7439
7440 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
7441 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
7442
7443
7444tcp-check send <data>
7445 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7446 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7447 no | no | yes | yes
7448
7449 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7450 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7451
7452 Examples :
7453 # look for the redis master server
7454 option tcp-check
7455 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7456 tcp-check expect string role:master
7457
7458 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7459 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
7460
7461
7462tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
7463 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
7464 tcp health check
7465 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7466 no | no | yes | yes
7467
7468 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7469 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7470 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
7471 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
7472 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
7473 hexadecimal string.
7474 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
7475
7476 Examples :
7477 # redis check in binary
7478 option tcp-check
7479 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
7480 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
7481
7482
7483 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7484 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
7485
7486
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007487tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7488 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007489 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7490 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007491 Arguments :
7492 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007493 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
7494 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007495
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007496 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007497
7498 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
7499 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007500 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
7501 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
7502 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
7503 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
7504 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
7505 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007506
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007507 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
7508 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
7509 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
7510 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007511
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007512 Five types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007513 - accept :
7514 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7515 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7516 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007517
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007518 - reject :
7519 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7520 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7521 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
7522 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
7523 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
7524 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
7525 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
7526 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
7527 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
7528 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
7529 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
7530 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007531
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007532 - expect-proxy layer4 :
7533 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
7534 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
7535 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
7536 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
7537 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
7538 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
7539 hosts.
7540
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007541 - capture <sample> len <length> :
7542 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
7543 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
7544 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
7545 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
7546 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
7547 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
7548 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
7549 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
7550 session life. Since it applies to Please check section 7.3 (Fetching
7551 samples) and "capture request header" for more information.
7552
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007553 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007554 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007555 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007556 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007557 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
7558 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007559 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007560 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
7561 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
7562 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
7563 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
7564 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007565
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007566 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007567 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02007568 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007569 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
7570 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
7571 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
7572 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007573
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007574 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
7575 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
7576 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
7577 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007578
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007579 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
7580 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
7581 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
7582 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
7583 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007584 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
7585 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
7586 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
7587 layer7 information is extracted.
7588
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007589 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
7590 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
7591 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
7592 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
7593 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007594
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007595 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7596 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7597 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007598
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007599 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
7600 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
7601 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007602
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007603 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007604 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007605 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007606
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007607 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
7608 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
7609 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007610
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007611 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007612 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7613 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007614
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007615 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
7616
7617 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
7618
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007619 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7620
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007621 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007622
7623
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007624tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7625 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007626 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007627 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007628 Arguments :
7629 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007630 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007631 "track-sc2" and "capture". See "tcp-request connection" above
7632 for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007633
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007634 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007635
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007636 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
7637 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7638 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
7639 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
7640 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007641
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007642 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
7643 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
7644 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
7645 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007646 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
7647 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
7648 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
7649 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
7650 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
7651 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007652 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007653 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007654
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007655 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7656 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7657 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7658 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007659
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007660 Four types of actions are supported :
7661 - accept : the request is accepted
7662 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
7663 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007664 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007665
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007666 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
7667 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007668
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007669 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
7670 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
7671 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
7672 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
7673 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
7674 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007675
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007676 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007677 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7678 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007679
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007680 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007681 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
7682 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
7683 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
7684 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007685 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
7686 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
7687 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007688
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007689 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02007690 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
7691 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
7692 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007693
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007694 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007695 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
7696 # and reject everything else.
7697 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
7698 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007699 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007700 tcp-request content reject
7701
7702 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007703 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
7704 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7705 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007706 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007707
7708 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
7709 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7710 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007711 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007712 tcp-request content reject
7713
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007714 Example:
7715 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
7716 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02007717 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007718
7719 Example:
7720 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
7721 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02007722 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007723
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007724 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
7725 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
7726
7727 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007728 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007729 # protecting all our sites
7730 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007731 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7732 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007733 ...
7734 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
7735
7736 backend http_dynamic
7737 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007738 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007739 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007740 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7741 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
7742 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007743 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007744
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007745 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007746
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007747 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007748
7749
7750tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
7751 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
7752 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007753 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007754 Arguments :
7755 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7756 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7757 as explained at the top of this document.
7758
7759 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
7760 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
7761 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
7762 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
7763 data for at most the specified amount of time.
7764
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007765 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
7766 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
7767 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
7768 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
7769
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007770 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
7771 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007772 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007773 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01007774 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
7775 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
7776 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
7777 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007778
7779 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
7780 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
7781 it pass through unaffected.
7782
7783 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
7784 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
7785 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007786 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007787 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
7788 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02007789 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
7790 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
7791 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007792
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007793 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007794 "timeout client".
7795
7796
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007797tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7798 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
7799 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7800 no | no | yes | yes
7801 Arguments :
7802 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007803 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007804
7805 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
7806
7807 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
7808 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7809 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007810 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
7811 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007812
7813 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
7814
7815 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7816 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7817 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7818 inserted.
7819
7820 Two types of actions are supported :
7821 - accept :
7822 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7823 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7824 the rules evaluation.
7825
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007826 - close :
7827 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
7828 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
7829 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
7830 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
7831 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
7832 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007833 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007834 protocols.
7835
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007836 - reject :
7837 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7838 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007839 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007840
7841 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7842 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7843 for changing the default action to a reject.
7844
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007845 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
7846 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
7847 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
7848 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007849 period.
7850
7851 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7852
7853 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
7854
7855
7856tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
7857 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
7858 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7859 no | no | yes | yes
7860 Arguments :
7861 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7862 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7863 as explained at the top of this document.
7864
7865 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
7866
7867
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007868timeout check <timeout>
7869 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
7870 established.
7871
7872 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7873 yes | no | yes | yes
7874 Arguments:
7875 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7876 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7877 as explained at the top of this document.
7878
7879 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
7880 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
7881 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
7882 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01007883 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
7884 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
7885 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007886
7887 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
7888 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
7889
7890 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
7891 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007892 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007893
7894 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7895 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7896 forget about it.
7897
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007898 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
7899 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007900
7901
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007902timeout client <timeout>
7903timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7904 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
7905 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7906 yes | yes | yes | no
7907 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007908 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007909 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7910 as explained at the top of this document.
7911
7912 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7913 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7914 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
7915 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
7916 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
7917 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
7918 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
7919 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007920 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007921 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007922 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
7923 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007924 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
7925 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007926
7927 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7928 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7929 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7930 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7931 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7932 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7933
7934 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
7935 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
7936 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7937
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007938 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007939
7940
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007941timeout client-fin <timeout>
7942 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
7943 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7944 yes | yes | yes | no
7945 Arguments :
7946 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7947 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7948 as explained at the top of this document.
7949
7950 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7951 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
7952 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
7953 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
7954 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
7955 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
7956 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
7957 down in one direction.
7958
7959 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7960 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
7961 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
7962
7963 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
7964
7965
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007966timeout connect <timeout>
7967timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7968 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
7969 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7970 yes | no | yes | yes
7971 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007972 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007973 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7974 as explained at the top of this document.
7975
7976 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007977 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007978 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007979 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007980 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
7981 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007982
7983 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7984 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7985 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7986 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7987 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
7988 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7989
7990 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
7991 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
7992 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7993
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007994 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
7995 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007996
7997
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007998timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
7999 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
8000 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8001 yes | yes | yes | yes
8002 Arguments :
8003 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8004 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8005 as explained at the top of this document.
8006
8007 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
8008 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
8009 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
8010 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
8011 once the request has started to present itself.
8012
8013 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
8014 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
8015 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
8016 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
8017 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
8018
8019 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
8020 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
8021 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
8022 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
8023
8024 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
8025 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
8026 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
8027 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
8028 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02008029 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008030
8031 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
8032 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
8033 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
8034 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
8035
8036 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
8037
8038
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008039timeout http-request <timeout>
8040 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
8041 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02008042 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008043 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008044 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008045 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8046 as explained at the top of this document.
8047
8048 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
8049 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
8050 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
8051 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
8052 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
8053 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
8054 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02008055 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
8056 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
8057 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
8058 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
8059 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
8060 code using "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See more details in the explanations of
8061 the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008062
8063 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
8064 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008065 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
8066 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008067
8068 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
8069 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
8070 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
8071 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
8072 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
8073
8074 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02008075 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
8076 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
8077 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008078
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02008079 See also : "errorfile", "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008080
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008081
8082timeout queue <timeout>
8083 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
8084 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8085 yes | no | yes | yes
8086 Arguments :
8087 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8088 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8089 as explained at the top of this document.
8090
8091 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
8092 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
8093 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
8094 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
8095 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
8096
8097 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
8098 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
8099 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
8100 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
8101
8102 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
8103
8104
8105timeout server <timeout>
8106timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8107 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
8108 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8109 yes | no | yes | yes
8110 Arguments :
8111 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8112 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8113 as explained at the top of this document.
8114
8115 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8116 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8117 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8118 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8119 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8120 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8121 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8122
8123 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8124 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8125 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8126 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8127 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008128 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008129 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008130 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
8131 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
8132 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
8133 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008134
8135 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8136 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8137 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8138 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8139 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8140 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8141
8142 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
8143 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
8144 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8145
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008146 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008147
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008148
8149timeout server-fin <timeout>
8150 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
8151 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8152 yes | no | yes | yes
8153 Arguments :
8154 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8155 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8156 as explained at the top of this document.
8157
8158 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8159 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
8160 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
8161 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
8162 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
8163 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
8164 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
8165 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
8166 situations, it should not be needed.
8167
8168 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8169 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
8170 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
8171
8172 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
8173
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008174
8175timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008176 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008177 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8178 yes | yes | yes | yes
8179 Arguments :
8180 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
8181 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8182 as explained at the top of this document.
8183
8184 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
8185 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
8186 defines how long it will be maintained open.
8187
8188 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8189 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8190 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
8191 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008192 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008193
8194 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
8195
8196
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008197timeout tunnel <timeout>
8198 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
8199 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8200 yes | no | yes | yes
8201 Arguments :
8202 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8203 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8204 as explained at the top of this document.
8205
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008206 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008207 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
8208 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
8209 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
8210 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
8211 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
8212 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
8213 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
8214 specified.
8215
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008216 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
8217 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
8218 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
8219 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
8220 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
8221 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
8222 state.
8223
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008224 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8225 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8226 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
8227 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
8228 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
8229
8230 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8231 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8232 forget about it.
8233
8234 Example :
8235 defaults http
8236 option http-server-close
8237 timeout connect 5s
8238 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008239 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008240 timeout server 30s
8241 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
8242
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008243 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008244
8245
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008246transparent (deprecated)
8247 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8248 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008249 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008250 Arguments : none
8251
8252 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
8253 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8254 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8255 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8256 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8257 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8258 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8259 appropriate server.
8260
8261 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
8262
8263 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8264 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8265
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008266 See also: "option transparent"
8267
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008268unique-id-format <string>
8269 Generate a unique ID for each request.
8270 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8271 yes | yes | yes | no
8272 Arguments :
8273 <string> is a log-format string.
8274
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008275 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
8276 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
8277 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
8278 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008279
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008280 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
8281 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
8282 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
8283 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
8284 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
8285 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
8286 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
8287 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008288
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008289 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
8290 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008291
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008292 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008293
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008294 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008295
8296 will generate:
8297
8298 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8299
8300 See also: "unique-id-header"
8301
8302unique-id-header <name>
8303 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
8304 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8305 yes | yes | yes | no
8306 Arguments :
8307 <name> is the name of the header.
8308
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008309 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
8310 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008311
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008312 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008313
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008314 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008315 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
8316
8317 will generate:
8318
8319 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8320
8321 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008322
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008323use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008324 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008325 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8326 no | yes | yes | no
8327 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008328 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
8329 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008330
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008331 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
8332 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008333
8334 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
8335 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
8336 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008337 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
8338 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
8339 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
8340 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008341
8342 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
8343 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
8344 assign the backend.
8345
8346 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
8347 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8348 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
8349 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
8350 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
8351 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
8352
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008353 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008354 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008355 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
8356 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
8357 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
8358
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008359 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
8360 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
8361 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
8362 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
8363 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
8364 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
8365 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
8366 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
8367 cannot be forced from the request.
8368
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008369 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008370 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
8371 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
8372
8373 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
8374 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008375
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008376
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008377use-server <server> if <condition>
8378use-server <server> unless <condition>
8379 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
8380 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8381 no | no | yes | yes
8382 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008383 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008384
8385 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
8386
8387 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
8388 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
8389 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
8390
8391 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
8392 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
8393 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
8394 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
8395 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
8396 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
8397 matches will assign the server.
8398
8399 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
8400 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
8401 with the next rules until one matches.
8402
8403 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
8404 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8405 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
8406 according to other persistence mechanisms.
8407
8408 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
8409 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
8410 stripped.
8411
8412 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
8413 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
8414 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
8415 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
8416
8417 Example :
8418 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
8419 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
8420 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
8421 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
8422 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
8423 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
8424 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
8425 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
8426 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
8427
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008428 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008429
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008430
84315. Bind and Server options
8432--------------------------
8433
8434The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
8435depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
8436settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
8437written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
8438described in this section.
8439
8440
84415.1. Bind options
8442-----------------
8443
8444The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
8445as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
8446no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
8447parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
8448while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
8449provided immediately after the setting name.
8450
8451The currently supported settings are the following ones.
8452
8453accept-proxy
8454 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +02008455 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
8456 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008457 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
8458 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
8459 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
8460 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
8461 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
8462 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
8463 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008464 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
8465 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008466
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008467alpn <protocols>
8468 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
8469 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
8470 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
8471 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
8472 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
8473 initial NPN extension.
8474
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008475backlog <backlog>
8476 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
8477 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
8478
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008479ecdhe <named curve>
8480 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01008481 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
8482 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008483
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008484ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008485 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8486 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8487 client's certificate.
8488
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008489ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
8490 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8491 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
8492 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
8493 error is ignored.
8494
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008495ciphers <ciphers>
8496 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
8497 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008498 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008499 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
8500 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
8501
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008502crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008503 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8504 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8505 to verify client's certificate.
8506
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008507crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008508 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8509 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
8510 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
8511 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
8512 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
8513 file.
8514
8515 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
8516 are loaded.
8517
8518 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02008519 that directory will be loaded unless their name ends with '.issuer' or
8520 '.ocsp' (reserved extensions). This directive may be specified multiple times
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008521 in order to load certificates from multiple files or directories. The
8522 certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server Name
8523 Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are
8524 supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the first
8525 hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
8526 www.sub.example.org).
8527
8528 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
8529 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
8530 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
8531 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
8532 recommended to load the default one first as a file.
8533
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02008534 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008535
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008536 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
8537 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +08008538 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008539 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
8540 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
8541 clients).
8542
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02008543 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
8544 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
8545 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
8546 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
8547 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
8548 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
8549 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
8550 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
8551 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
8552 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
8553 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
8554 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
8555 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
8556
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008557crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008558 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
8559 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008560 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008561 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008562
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008563crt-list <file>
8564 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008565 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
8566 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008567
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008568 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008569
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008570 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
8571 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
8572 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
8573 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
8574 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
8575 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
8576 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
8577 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008578
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008579defer-accept
8580 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8581 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
8582 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
8583 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
8584 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
8585 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
8586 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
8587 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
8588 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
8589 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
8590 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
8591
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008592force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008593 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008594 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008595 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
8596 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008597
8598force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008599 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008600 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8601 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008602
8603force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008604 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008605 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8606 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008607
8608force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008609 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008610 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8611 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008612
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008613gid <gid>
8614 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
8615 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8616 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
8617 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
8618 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8619
8620group <group>
8621 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
8622 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
8623 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
8624 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
8625 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8626
8627id <id>
8628 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
8629 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
8630 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
8631 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
8632
8633interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01008634 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
8635 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
8636 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
8637 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
8638 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
8639 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
8640 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008641
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02008642level <level>
8643 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
8644 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
8645 sockets. <level> can be one of :
8646 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
8647 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
8648 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
8649 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
8650 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
8651 counters).
8652 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
8653 all counters).
8654
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008655maxconn <maxconn>
8656 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
8657 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
8658 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
8659 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
8660 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
8661 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
8662 eat all memory.
8663
8664mode <mode>
8665 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
8666 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
8667 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
8668 UNIX sockets.
8669
8670mss <maxseg>
8671 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
8672 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
8673 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
8674 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
8675 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
8676 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
8677 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
8678 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
8679 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
8680 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
8681 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
8682
8683name <name>
8684 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
8685 page.
8686
8687nice <nice>
8688 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
8689 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
8690 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
8691 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
8692 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
8693 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
8694 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
8695 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
8696 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
8697 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
8698 one for an RDP socket.
8699
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008700no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008701 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008702 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008703 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008704 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
8705 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "force-tls*",
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008706 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008707
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02008708no-tls-tickets
8709 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8710 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8711 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008712 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
8713 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02008714
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008715no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008716 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008717 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008718 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008719 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
8720 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
8721 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008722
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008723no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008724 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008725 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008726 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008727 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
8728 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
8729 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008730
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008731no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008732 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008733 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008734 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008735 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
8736 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
8737 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008738
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008739npn <protocols>
8740 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
8741 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
8742 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
8743 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008744 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
8745 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008746
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02008747process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
8748 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
8749 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
8750 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
8751 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
8752 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
8753 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
8754 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +02008755 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
8756 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
8757 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
8758 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
8759 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
8760 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
8761 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02008762
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008763ssl
8764 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008765 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008766 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
8767 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
8768 to deciphered contents.
8769
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01008770strict-sni
8771 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
8772 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
8773 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
8774 See the "crt" option for more information.
8775
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008776tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01008777 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008778 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
8779 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
8780 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
8781 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
8782 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
8783 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
8784 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02008785 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
8786 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
8787 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008788
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008789transparent
8790 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8791 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
8792 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
8793 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
8794 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
8795 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
8796 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
8797 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
8798 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
8799 so check for support with your vendor.
8800
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008801v4v6
8802 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8803 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
8804 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
8805 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008806 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008807
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008808v6only
8809 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8810 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
8811 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008812 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
8813 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008814
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008815uid <uid>
8816 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
8817 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8818 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
8819 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
8820 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8821
8822user <user>
8823 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
8824 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8825 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
8826 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
8827 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8828
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008829verify [none|optional|required]
8830 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
8831 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
8832 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
8833 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
8834 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008835 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
8836 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
8837 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
8838 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008839
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020088405.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008841------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008842
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008843The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
8844which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
8845arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
8846settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
8847after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
8848Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
8849address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008850
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008851 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008852 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008853
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008854The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008855
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008856addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008857 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
8858 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
8859 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
8860 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
8861 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008862
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008863 Supported in default-server: No
8864
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008865agent-check
8866 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008867 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
8868 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
8869 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
8870 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008871
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008872 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008873 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +02008874 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
8875 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
8876 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008877
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008878 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8879 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008880
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008881 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8882 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
8883 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008884
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008885 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8886 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
8887 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008888
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008889 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
8890 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
8891 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
8892 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
8893 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
8894 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
8895 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008896
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008897 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
8898 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008899
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008900 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
8901 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
8902 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
8903 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
8904 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
8905 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
8906 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
8907 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
8908 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008909
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008910 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
8911 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008912 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
8913 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
8914 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
8915 force an agent's result in order to workaround a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008916
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008917 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
8918 parameter.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008919
8920 Supported in default-server: No
8921
8922agent-inter <delay>
8923 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
8924 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8925
8926 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
8927 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
8928 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
8929 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
8930 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8931 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8932 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8933 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8934 of backends use the same servers.
8935
8936 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
8937
8938 Supported in default-server: Yes
8939
8940agent-port <port>
8941 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
8942
8943 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
8944
8945 Supported in default-server: Yes
8946
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008947backup
8948 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
8949 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
8950 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
8951 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
8952 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
8953 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008954
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008955 Supported in default-server: No
8956
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008957ca-file <cafile>
8958 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8959 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8960 server's certificate.
8961
8962 Supported in default-server: No
8963
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008964check
8965 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01008966 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
8967 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
8968 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
8969 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
8970 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
8971 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
8972 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008973 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
8974 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
8975 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008976
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008977 Supported in default-server: No
8978
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008979check-send-proxy
8980 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
8981 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
8982 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
8983 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
8984 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
8985 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
8986 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
8987
8988 Supported in default-server: No
8989
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008990check-ssl
8991 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
8992 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
8993 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
8994 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008995 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008996 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
8997 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
8998 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
8999 See the "ssl" option for more information.
9000
9001 Supported in default-server: No
9002
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009003ciphers <ciphers>
9004 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009005 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009006 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
9007 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
9008 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
9009 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
9010 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
9011 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
9012
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009013 Supported in default-server: No
9014
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009015cookie <value>
9016 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
9017 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
9018 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
9019 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
9020 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
9021 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
9022 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
9023
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009024 Supported in default-server: No
9025
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009026crl-file <crlfile>
9027 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9028 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
9029 to verify server's certificate.
9030
9031 Supported in default-server: No
9032
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02009033crt <cert>
9034 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
9035 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
9036 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
9037 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
9038 certificate request.
9039
9040 Supported in default-server: No
9041
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02009042disabled
9043 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
9044 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
9045 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
9046 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
9047 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
9048
9049 Supported in default-server: No
9050
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009051error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01009052 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
9053 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
9054 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009055
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009056 Supported in default-server: Yes
9057
9058 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009059
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009060fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009061 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
9062 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
9063 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
9064
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009065 Supported in default-server: Yes
9066
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009067force-sslv3
9068 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
9069 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009070 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
9071 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009072
9073 Supported in default-server: No
9074
9075force-tlsv10
9076 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009077 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9078 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009079
9080 Supported in default-server: No
9081
9082force-tlsv11
9083 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009084 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9085 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009086
9087 Supported in default-server: No
9088
9089force-tlsv12
9090 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009091 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9092 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009093
9094 Supported in default-server: No
9095
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009096id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02009097 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
9098 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
9099 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009100
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009101 Supported in default-server: No
9102
9103inter <delay>
9104fastinter <delay>
9105downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009106 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
9107 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
9108 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
9109 between checks depending on the server state :
9110
9111 Server state | Interval used
9112 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9113 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
9114 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9115 Transitionally UP (going down), |
9116 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
9117 or yet unchecked. |
9118 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9119 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
9120 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009121
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009122 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
9123 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
9124 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
9125 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009126 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
9127 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
9128 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
9129 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
9130 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009131
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009132 Supported in default-server: Yes
9133
9134maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009135 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
9136 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
9137 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
9138 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
9139 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
9140 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
9141 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
9142 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
9143
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009144 Supported in default-server: Yes
9145
9146maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009147 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
9148 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
9149 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
9150 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
9151 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
9152 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
9153 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
9154
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009155 Supported in default-server: Yes
9156
9157minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009158 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
9159 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
9160 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
9161 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
9162 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
9163 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009164 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009165 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009166
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009167 Supported in default-server: Yes
9168
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009169no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009170 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
9171 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009172 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009173
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009174 Supported in default-server: No
9175
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02009176no-tls-tickets
9177 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9178 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
9179 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009180 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
9181 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02009182
9183 Supported in default-server: No
9184
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009185no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009186 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009187 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9188 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009189 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9190 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9191 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009192
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009193 Supported in default-server: No
9194
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009195no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009196 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009197 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9198 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009199 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9200 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9201 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009202
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009203 Supported in default-server: No
9204
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009205no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009206 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009207 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9208 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009209 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9210 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9211 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009212
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009213 Supported in default-server: No
9214
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09009215non-stick
9216 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
9217 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
9218 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
9219
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009220 Supported in default-server: No
9221
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009222observe <mode>
9223 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
9224 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
9225 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
9226 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
9227 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
9228 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01009229 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009230
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009231 Supported in default-server: No
9232
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009233 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
9234
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009235on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009236 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
9237 Currently, four modes are available:
9238 - fastinter: force fastinter
9239 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
9240 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
9241 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
9242 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
9243
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009244 Supported in default-server: Yes
9245
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009246 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
9247
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009248on-marked-down <action>
9249 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
9250 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009251 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
9252 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
9253 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
9254 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
9255 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
9256 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
9257 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
9258 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009259
9260 Actions are disabled by default
9261
9262 Supported in default-server: Yes
9263
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009264on-marked-up <action>
9265 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
9266 Currently one action is available:
9267 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
9268 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
9269 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
9270 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
9271 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
9272 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
9273 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
9274 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
9275
9276 Actions are disabled by default
9277
9278 Supported in default-server: Yes
9279
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009280port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009281 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
9282 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
9283 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
9284 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
9285 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
9286 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
9287
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009288 Supported in default-server: Yes
9289
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009290redir <prefix>
9291 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
9292 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
9293 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
9294 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
9295 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
9296 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
9297 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
9298 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009299 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009300 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
9301 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
9302 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
9303 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
9304 loop between the client and HAProxy!
9305
9306 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
9307
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009308 Supported in default-server: No
9309
9310rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009311 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
9312 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
9313 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
9314
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009315 Supported in default-server: Yes
9316
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009317send-proxy
9318 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
9319 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
9320 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
9321 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
9322 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
9323 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
9324 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
9325 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
9326 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02009327 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
9328 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
9329 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
9330 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
9331 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009332
9333 Supported in default-server: No
9334
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -04009335send-proxy-v2
9336 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
9337 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9338 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9339 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9340 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
9341 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
9342 option of the "bind" keyword.
9343
9344 Supported in default-server: No
9345
9346send-proxy-v2-ssl
9347 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9348 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9349 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9350 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9351 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9352 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
9353 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
9354 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9355
9356 Supported in default-server: No
9357
9358send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
9359 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9360 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9361 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9362 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9363 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9364 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
9365 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
9366 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
9367 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9368
9369 Supported in default-server: No
9370
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009371slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009372 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
9373 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
9374 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
9375 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
9376 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
9377 parameters :
9378
9379 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
9380 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
9381
9382 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
9383 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
9384 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
9385 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
9386
9387 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
9388 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
9389 seen as failed.
9390
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009391 Supported in default-server: Yes
9392
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009393source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009394source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009395source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009396 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
9397 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
9398 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
9399 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
9400
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009401 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
9402 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
9403 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
9404 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
9405 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
9406 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
9407 server.
9408
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009409 Supported in default-server: No
9410
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009411ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009412 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
9413 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
9414 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
9415 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
9416 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
9417 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009418 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009419
9420 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009421
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009422track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +02009423 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
9424 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
9425 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
9426 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009427 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
9428
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009429 Supported in default-server: No
9430
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009431verify [none|required]
9432 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01009433 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
9434 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
9435 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
9436 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009437 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
9438 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
9439 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009440
9441 Supported in default-server: No
9442
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -07009443verifyhost <hostname>
9444 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
9445 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
9446 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
9447 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
9448 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
9449 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
9450
9451 Supported in default-server: No
9452
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009453weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009454 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
9455 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
9456 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02009457 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
9458 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
9459 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
9460 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
9461 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
9462 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009463
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009464 Supported in default-server: Yes
9465
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009466
94676. HTTP header manipulation
9468---------------------------
9469
9470In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
9471response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
9472request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
9473which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009474against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009475
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009476If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
9477to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
9478but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
9479HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
9480stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
9481because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
9482a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
9483still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02009484
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009485This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
9486in section 4.2 :
9487
9488 - reqadd <string>
9489 - reqallow <search>
9490 - reqiallow <search>
9491 - reqdel <search>
9492 - reqidel <search>
9493 - reqdeny <search>
9494 - reqideny <search>
9495 - reqpass <search>
9496 - reqipass <search>
9497 - reqrep <search> <replace>
9498 - reqirep <search> <replace>
9499 - reqtarpit <search>
9500 - reqitarpit <search>
9501 - rspadd <string>
9502 - rspdel <search>
9503 - rspidel <search>
9504 - rspdeny <search>
9505 - rspideny <search>
9506 - rsprep <search> <replace>
9507 - rspirep <search> <replace>
9508
9509With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
9510is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
9511parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
9512prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
9513Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
9514
9515 \t for a tab
9516 \r for a carriage return (CR)
9517 \n for a new line (LF)
9518 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
9519 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
9520 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
9521 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
9522 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
9523
9524The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
9525portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
9526above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
9527regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
95289 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
9529is very common to users of the "sed" program.
9530
9531The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
9532after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
9533
9534Notes related to these keywords :
9535---------------------------------
9536 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
9537 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
9538 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
9539
9540 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
9541 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
9542 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
9543
9544 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
9545 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
9546 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
9547 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
9548 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
9549
9550 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
9551 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
9552 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
9553 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
9554 useless headers before adding new ones.
9555
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009556 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009557 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
9558
9559 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
9560 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
9561 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
9562
9563 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
9564 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009565 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009566
9567
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020095687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
9569----------------------------------
9570
9571Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
9572client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
9573The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
9574these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
9575but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
9576data called patterns.
9577
9578
95797.1. ACL basics
9580---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009581
9582The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
9583content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
9584from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
9585simple :
9586
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009587 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009588 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009589 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
9590 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009591
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009592The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
9593adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009594
9595In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
9596
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009597 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009598
9599This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
9600Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
9601and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009602an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
9603conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
9604as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
9605are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009606
9607ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
9608'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
9609which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
9610
9611There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
9612performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
9613
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009614The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
9615specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
9616this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009617methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
9618ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009619
9620Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
9621 - boolean
9622 - integer (signed or unsigned)
9623 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
9624 - string
9625 - data block
9626
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009627Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
9628converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
9629would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
9630The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
9631which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
9632
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009633Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
9634keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
9635fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
9636which are summarized in the table below :
9637
9638 +---------------------+-----------------+
9639 | Sample or converter | Default |
9640 | output type | matching method |
9641 +---------------------+-----------------+
9642 | boolean | bool |
9643 +---------------------+-----------------+
9644 | integer | int |
9645 +---------------------+-----------------+
9646 | ip | ip |
9647 +---------------------+-----------------+
9648 | string | str |
9649 +---------------------+-----------------+
9650 | binary | none, use "-m" |
9651 +---------------------+-----------------+
9652
9653Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
9654matching method, see below.
9655
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009656The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
9657 - boolean
9658 - integer or integer range
9659 - IP address / network
9660 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
9661 - regular expression
9662 - hex block
9663
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009664The following ACL flags are currently supported :
9665
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009666 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
9667 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009668 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009669 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009670 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009671 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009672 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
9673
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009674The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
9675read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
9676if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
9677lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
9678will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
9679beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
9680a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
9681lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
9682exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
9683
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009684The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
9685parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
9686ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
9687a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
9688check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
9689
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009690The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
9691socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
9692file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
9693
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009694Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
9695loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
9696
9697 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
9698
9699In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
9700the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
9701case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
9702as well.
9703
9704The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
9705sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
9706do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
9707methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
9708is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
9709obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
9710followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
9711default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
9712that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
9713string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
9714
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009715The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
9716By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
9717string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
9718resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
9719server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
9720waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
9721flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
9722function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
9723
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009724There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
9725sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
9726be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009727
9728 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
9729 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009730 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
9731 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
9732 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
9733 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009734
9735 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
9736 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009737 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009738
9739 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009740 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009741
9742 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009743 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009744
9745 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
9746 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
9747
9748 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
9749 binary or string samples.
9750
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009751 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
9752 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009753
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009754 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
9755 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
9756 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009757
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009758 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
9759 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009760
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009761 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
9762 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009763
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009764 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
9765 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009766
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009767 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
9768 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009769 This may be used with binary or string samples.
9770
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009771 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
9772 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
9773 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009774
9775For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
9776request, it is possible to do :
9777
9778 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
9779
9780In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
9781buffer, one would use the following acl :
9782
9783 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
9784
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009785On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
9786possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
9787
9788 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
9789
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009790All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
9791criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
9792method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
9793to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
9794criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
9795the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009796
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009797If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009798the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
9799For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009800
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009801 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
9802 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
9803 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
9804 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009805
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009806
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009807The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
9808types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
9809combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
9810brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
9811default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009812
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009813 +-------------------------------------------------+
9814 | Input sample type |
9815 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009816 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009817 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9818 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
9819 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009820 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009821 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009822 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009823 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009824 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009825 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009826 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009827 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009828 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009829 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009830 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009831 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009832 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009833 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009834 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009835 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009836 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009837 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009838 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009839 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009840 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009841 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9842 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
9843 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009844
9845
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020098467.1.1. Matching booleans
9847------------------------
9848
9849In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
9850Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
9851When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
9852that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
9853
9854Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
9855return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
9856"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
9857
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009858
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020098597.1.2. Matching integers
9860------------------------
9861
9862Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
9863enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
9864to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
9865
9866Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
9867matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
9868lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009869
9870For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
9871unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
9872representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
9873
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009874As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
9875two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
9876instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
9877ranges and operators.
9878
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009879For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009880operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
9881Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
9882of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009883
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009884Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009885
9886 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
9887 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
9888 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
9889 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
9890 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
9891
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009892For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009893
9894 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
9895
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009896This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
9897
9898 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
9899
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009900
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020099017.1.3. Matching strings
9902-----------------------
9903
9904String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
9905different forms :
9906
9907 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
9908 patterns ;
9909
9910 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
9911 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
9912
9913 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
9914 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9915
9916 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
9917 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9918
9919 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9920 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
9921 matches.
9922
9923 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9924 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
9925 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009926
9927String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
9928exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
9929characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
9930string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
9931to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009932before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009933
9934
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020099357.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
9936---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009937
9938Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
9939they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
9940possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
9941passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
9942the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009943the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
9944match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009945
9946
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020099477.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
9948-------------------------------------
9949
9950It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
9951not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
9952a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
9953to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
9954digits may be used upper or lower case.
9955
9956Example :
9957 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
9958 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
9959
9960
99617.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
9962---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009963
9964IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
9965netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
9966within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009967host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009968difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
9969at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
9970does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
9971parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009972
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009973IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
9974Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
9975trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
9976IPv6 patterns.
9977
9978HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
9979following situations :
9980 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
9981 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
9982 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
9983 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
9984 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
9985 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
9986 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
9987 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
9988 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
9989 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
9990
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009991
99927.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
9993----------------------------------
9994
9995Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
9996combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
9997
9998 - AND (implicit)
9999 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
10000 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010001
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010002A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010003
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010004 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020010005
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010006Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
10007indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020010008
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010009For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
10010"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
10011requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
10012is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
10013
10014 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
10015 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
10016 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
10017 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
10018
10019To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
10020and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
10021
10022 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
10023 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
10024 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
10025 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
10026
10027 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
10028 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
10029 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
10030 use_backend www if host_www
10031
10032It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
10033expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
10034be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
10035the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
10036
10037 The following rule :
10038
10039 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
10040 block if METH_POST missing_cl
10041
10042 Can also be written that way :
10043
10044 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
10045
10046It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
10047to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
10048simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
10049sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
10050good use is the following :
10051
10052 With named ACLs :
10053
10054 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
10055 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
10056 monitor fail if site_dead
10057
10058 With anonymous ACLs :
10059
10060 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
10061
10062See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
10063
10064
100657.3. Fetching samples
10066---------------------
10067
10068Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
10069against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
10070sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
10071ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
10072of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
10073available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
10074
10075This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
10076Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
10077compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
10078deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
10079
10080The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
10081matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
10082method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
10083indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
10084
10085As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
10086when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
10087mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
10088the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
10089ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
10090
10091Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
10092multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
10093when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
10094incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
10095are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
10096is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
10097all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
10098
10099Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
10100 - name
10101 - name(arg1)
10102 - name(arg1,arg2)
10103
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010104
101057.3.1. Converters
10106-----------------
10107
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010108Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
10109of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
10110is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
10111was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
10112has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
10113unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
10114
10115These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
10116sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
10117the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
10118support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010119
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010120The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010121
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020010122base64
10123 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
10124 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
10125 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
10126
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010010127bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
10128 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
10129 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
10130 optionnaly truncated at the given length.
10131
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010010132crc32([<avalanche>])
10133 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
10134 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
10135 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
10136 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
10137 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
10138 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
10139 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
10140 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
10141 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
10142 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
10143 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6" and the "hash-type" directive.
10144
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010145djb2([<avalanche>])
10146 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
10147 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
10148 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
10149 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
10150 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
10151 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
10152 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010010153 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6" and the
10154 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010155
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010010156field(<index>,<delimiters>)
10157 Extracts the substring at the given index considering given delimiters from
10158 an input string. Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted
10159 list of chars.
10160
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010161hex
10162 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
10163 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
10164 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
10165 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010010166
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010167http_date([<offset>])
10168 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
10169 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
10170 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
10171 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
10172 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
10173 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010174
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020010175in_table(<table>)
10176 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10177 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
10178 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
10179 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (eg: whether
10180 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
10181
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010182ipmask(<mask>)
10183 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
10184 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
10185 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
10186 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
10187
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020010188json([<input-code>])
10189 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII ouput string ready to use as a
10190 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
10191 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8"" or
10192 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
10193 of errors:
10194 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
10195 bytes, ...)
10196 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
10197 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
10198
10199 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
10200 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
10201 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
10202 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
10203 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
10204 are :
10205 - "ascii" : never fails ;
10206 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors ;
10207 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors ;
10208 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
10209 error ;
10210 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
10211 characters corresponding to the other errors.
10212
10213 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
10214 logging to servers which consume JSON-formated traffic logs.
10215
10216 Example:
10217 capture request header user-agent len 150
10218 capture request header Host len 15
10219 log-format {"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json]"}
10220
10221 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
10222 GET / HTTP/1.0
10223 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
10224
10225 Output log:
10226 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
10227
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010228language(<value>[,<default>])
10229 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
10230 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
10231 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
10232 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
10233 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
10234 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
10235 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
10236 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
10237 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
10238 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
10239 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
10240 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010241
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010242 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010243
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010244 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
10245 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010246
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010247 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
10248 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
10249 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
10250 use_backend spanish if es
10251 use_backend french if fr
10252 use_backend english if en
10253 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010254
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010255lower
10256 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
10257 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
10258 type. The result is of type string.
10259
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020010260ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
10261 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
10262 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
10263 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
10264 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
10265 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
10266 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
10267
10268 Example :
10269
10270 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
10271 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
10272 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
10273
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010274map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10275map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10276map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10277 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
10278 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
10279 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
10280 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
10281 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
10282 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
10283 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
10284 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010285
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010286 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
10287 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
10288 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010289
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010290 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
10291 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010292
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010293 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
10294 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10295 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
10296 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020010297 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
10298 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010299 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
10300 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10301 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
10302 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10303 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
10304 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10305 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
10306 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10307 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
10308 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10309 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
10310 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10311 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
10312 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010313
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010314 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
10315 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
10316 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
10317 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
10318 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010319
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010320 Example :
10321
10322 # this is a comment and is ignored
10323 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
10324 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
10325 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
10326 | | | `---------- value
10327 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
10328 | `---------------------------- key
10329 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
10330
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010010331regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>)
10332 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
10333 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
10334 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
10335 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
10336 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
10337 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
10338 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
10339 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
10340 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
10341 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
10342 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis or comma
10343 are not possible to use in the arguments. The first use of this converter is
10344 to replace certain characters or sequence of characters with other ones.
10345
10346 Example :
10347
10348 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
10349 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
10350 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
10351 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
10352
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010353sdbm([<avalanche>])
10354 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
10355 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
10356 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
10357 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
10358 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
10359 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
10360 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010010361 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6" and the
10362 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010363
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020010364table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
10365 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10366 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10367 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
10368 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
10369 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
10370 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
10371
10372
10373table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
10374 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10375 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10376 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
10377 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
10378 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
10379 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
10380
10381table_conn_cnt(<table>)
10382 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10383 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10384 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
10385 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
10386 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
10387
10388table_conn_cur(<table>)
10389 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10390 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10391 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
10392 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
10393 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
10394
10395table_conn_rate(<table>)
10396 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10397 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10398 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
10399 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
10400 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
10401
10402table_gpc0(<table>)
10403 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10404 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10405 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
10406 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
10407 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
10408
10409table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
10410 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10411 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10412 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
10413 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
10414 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
10415 sample fetch keyword.
10416
10417table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
10418 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10419 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10420 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
10421 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
10422 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
10423
10424table_http_err_rate(<table>)
10425 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10426 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10427 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
10428 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
10429 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
10430 keyword.
10431
10432table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
10433 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10434 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10435 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
10436 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
10437 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
10438
10439table_http_req_rate(<table>)
10440 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10441 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10442 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
10443 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
10444 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
10445 keyword.
10446
10447table_kbytes_in(<table>)
10448 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10449 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10450 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of client-
10451 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
10452 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
10453 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
10454 keyword.
10455
10456table_kbytes_out(<table>)
10457 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10458 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10459 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of server-
10460 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
10461 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
10462 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
10463 keyword.
10464
10465table_server_id(<table>)
10466 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10467 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10468 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
10469 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
10470 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
10471 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
10472
10473table_sess_cnt(<table>)
10474 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10475 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10476 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
10477 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
10478 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
10479 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
10480 keyword.
10481
10482table_sess_rate(<table>)
10483 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10484 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10485 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
10486 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
10487 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
10488 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
10489 keyword.
10490
10491table_trackers(<table>)
10492 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10493 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10494 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
10495 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
10496 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
10497 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
10498 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
10499 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
10500 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
10501 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
10502
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010503upper
10504 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
10505 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
10506 type. The result is of type string.
10507
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020010508utime(<format>[,<offset>])
10509 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
10510 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
10511 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
10512 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
10513 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
10514 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
10515
10516 Example :
10517
10518 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
10519 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
10520 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
10521
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010010522word(<index>,<delimiters>)
10523 Extracts the nth word considering given delimiters from an input string.
10524 Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
10525
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010526wt6([<avalanche>])
10527 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
10528 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
10529 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
10530 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
10531 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
10532 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
10533 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010010534 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", and the
10535 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010536
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010537
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200105387.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010539--------------------------------------------
10540
10541A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
10542not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
10543"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
10544The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
10545
10546always_false : boolean
10547 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
10548 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
10549
10550always_true : boolean
10551 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
10552 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
10553
10554avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010555 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010556 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
10557 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
10558 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
10559 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
10560 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
10561 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
10562 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
10563 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
10564 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
10565 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
10566 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
10567 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
10568 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010010569
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010570be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010571 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
10572 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
10573 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
10574 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
10575 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010576
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010577be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
10578 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10579 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
10580 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
10581 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
10582 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
10583 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010584
10585 Example :
10586 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
10587 backend dynamic
10588 mode http
10589 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
10590 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010591
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010592connslots([<backend>]) : integer
10593 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010594 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010595 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
10596 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050010597
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010598 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010599 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010600 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
10601
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010602 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
10603 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010604
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010605 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010606 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010607 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010608 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
10609 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010610 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010611 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010612
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010613 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
10614 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010615 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010616 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010617
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020010618date([<offset>]) : integer
10619 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
10620 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
10621 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
10622 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020010623 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
10624
10625 Example :
10626
10627 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
10628 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020010629
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020010630env(<name>) : string
10631 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
10632 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
10633 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
10634 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
10635 certain way.
10636
10637 Examples :
10638 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
10639 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
10640
10641 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
10642 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
10643
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010644fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
10645 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010646 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
10647 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010648 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
10649 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
10650 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
10651 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
10652 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010653
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010654fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
10655 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10656 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
10657 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
10658 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
10659 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
10660 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
10661 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
10662 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010663
10664 Example :
10665 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
10666 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
10667 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
10668 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
10669 frontend mail
10670 bind :25
10671 mode tcp
10672 maxconn 100
10673 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
10674 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
10675 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
10676 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010677
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010010678nbproc : integer
10679 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
10680 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
10681 and debugging purposes.
10682
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010683nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
10684 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
10685 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
10686 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010687 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
10688 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
10689 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010690
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010010691proc : integer
10692 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
10693 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
10694 debugging purposes.
10695
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010696queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010697 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
10698 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
10699 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010700 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
10701 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
10702 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
10703 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
10704 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
10705
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010010706rand([<range>]) : integer
10707 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
10708 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
10709 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
10710 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
10711 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
10712
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010713srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
10714 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
10715 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
10716 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
10717 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
10718 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
10719 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
10720 methods.
10721
10722srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
10723 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
10724 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
10725 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
10726 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
10727 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
10728 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
10729 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
10730
10731srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
10732 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10733 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010734 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010735 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
10736 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
10737 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
10738 overloading servers).
10739
10740 Example :
10741 # Redirect to a separate back
10742 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
10743 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
10744 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
10745
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010010746stopping : boolean
10747 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
10748 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
10749 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
10750
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010751table_avl([<table>]) : integer
10752 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
10753 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
10754
10755table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10756 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
10757 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
10758 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
10759
10760
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200107617.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010762----------------------------------
10763
10764The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
10765closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
10766methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
10767sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
10768TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010769the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
10770counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
10771"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010772argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
10773the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
10774this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010775
10776be_id : integer
10777 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
10778 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
10779
10780dst : ip
10781 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
10782 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
10783 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
10784 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
10785 RFC 4291.
10786
10787dst_conn : integer
10788 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
10789 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
10790 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
10791 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
10792 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
10793 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
10794 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
10795 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010796
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010797dst_port : integer
10798 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
10799 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
10800 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
10801 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
10802 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
10803 an HTTP header.
10804
10805fe_id : integer
10806 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
10807 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
10808 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
10809
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010810sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010811sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10812sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10813sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010814 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
10815 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
10816 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
10817
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010818sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010819sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10820sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10821sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010822 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
10823 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
10824 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
10825
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010826sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010827sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10828sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10829sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010830 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
10831 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010832 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
10833 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
10834 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010835
10836 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
10837 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010838 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
10839 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
10840 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010841 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
10842 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10843
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010844sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010845sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10846sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10847sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010848 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
10849 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
10850
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010851sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010852sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
10853sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
10854sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010855 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
10856 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
10857 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
10858
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010859sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010860sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10861sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10862sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010863 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
10864 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
10865 See also src_conn_rate.
10866
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010867sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010868sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10869sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10870sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010871 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010872 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010873
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010874sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010875sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
10876sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
10877sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010878 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
10879 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
10880 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010881 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
10882 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
10883 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010884
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010885sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010886sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10887sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10888sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010889 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
10890 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
10891 See also src_http_err_cnt.
10892
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010893sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010894sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10895sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10896sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010897 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
10898 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
10899 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
10900 src_http_err_rate.
10901
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010902sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010903sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10904sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10905sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010906 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
10907 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
10908 src_http_req_cnt.
10909
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010910sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010911sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10912sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10913sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010914 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
10915 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
10916 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
10917 src_http_req_rate.
10918
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010919sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010920sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10921sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10922sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010923 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010924 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
10925 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
10926 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
10927 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010928
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010929 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
10930 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010931 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10932
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010933sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010934sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10935sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10936sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020010937 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
10938 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
10939 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010940
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010941sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010942sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10943sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10944sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020010945 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
10946 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
10947 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010948
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010949sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010950sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10951sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10952sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010953 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
10954 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
10955 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
10956 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010957 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010958 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
10959
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010960sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010961sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10962sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10963sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010964 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
10965 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
10966 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
10967 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
10968 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010969 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010970
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010971sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010972sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
10973sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
10974sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020010975 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
10976 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
10977 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
10978
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010979sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010980sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
10981sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
10982sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010983 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
10984 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010985 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010986 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
10987 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010988 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
10989 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
10990 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010991
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010992so_id : integer
10993 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
10994 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
10995 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010996
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010997src : ip
10998 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
10999 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
11000 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
11001 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
11002 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
11003 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
11004 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011005
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011006 Example:
11007 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
11008 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
11009
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011010src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
11011 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
11012 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
11013 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011014 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011015
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011016src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
11017 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
11018 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011019 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011020 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011021
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011022src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11023 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
11024 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
11025 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
11026 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
11027 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
11028 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011029
11030 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
11031 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
11032 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
11033 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010011034 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011035 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
11036 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
11037
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011038src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011039 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011040 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011041 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011042 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011043
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011044src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011045 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011046 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
11047 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011048 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011049
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011050src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
11051 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
11052 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
11053 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011054 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011055
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011056src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011057 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011058 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011059 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011060 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011061
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011062src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011063 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011064 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011065 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
11066 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011067 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
11068 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
11069 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011070
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011071src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11072 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
11073 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011074 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011075 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011076 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011077
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011078src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
11079 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
11080 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
11081 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
11082 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011083 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011084
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011085src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11086 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
11087 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
11088 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011089 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011090
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011091src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
11092 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
11093 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
11094 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011095 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011096 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011097
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011098src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11099 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
11100 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
11101 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011102 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011103 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
11104 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011105
11106 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010011107 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011108 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011109
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011110src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020011111 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
11112 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
11113 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
11114 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
11115 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011116
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011117src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020011118 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
11119 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
11120 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
11121 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
11122 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020011123
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011124src_port : integer
11125 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
11126 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
11127 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
11128 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010011129
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011130src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11131 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011132 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
11133 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
11134 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011135 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011136
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011137src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
11138 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
11139 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
11140 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
11141 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011142 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011143
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011144src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11145 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
11146 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
11147 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
11148 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
11149 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
11150 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
11151 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
11152 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020011153
11154 Example :
11155 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
11156 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
11157 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
11158 listen ssh
11159 bind :22
11160 mode tcp
11161 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011162 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011163 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020011164 server local 127.0.0.1:22
11165
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011166srv_id : integer
11167 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
11168 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
11169 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020011170
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +010011171
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200111727.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011173----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020011174
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011175The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
11176closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
11177when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
11178usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011179future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020011180
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020011181ssl_bc : boolean
11182 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
11183 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
11184 other a server with the "ssl" option.
11185
11186ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
11187 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
11188 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11189
11190ssl_bc_cipher : string
11191 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
11192 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11193
11194ssl_bc_protocol : string
11195 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
11196 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11197
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011198ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020011199 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011200 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
11201 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020011202
11203ssl_bc_session_id : binary
11204 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
11205 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
11206 if session was reused or not.
11207
11208ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
11209 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
11210 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11211
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011212ssl_c_ca_err : integer
11213 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11214 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
11215 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
11216 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
11217 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020011218
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011219ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
11220 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11221 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
11222 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
11223 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011224
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010011225ssl_c_der : binary
11226 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
11227 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11228 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
11229
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011230ssl_c_err : integer
11231 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11232 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
11233 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
11234 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
11235 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011236
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011237ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11238 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11239 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
11240 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11241 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
11242 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
11243 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11244 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11245 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011246
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011247ssl_c_key_alg : string
11248 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
11249 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11250 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011251
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011252ssl_c_notafter : string
11253 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
11254 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11255 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020011256
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011257ssl_c_notbefore : string
11258 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
11259 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11260 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010011261
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011262ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11263 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11264 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
11265 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11266 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
11267 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
11268 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11269 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11270 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010011271
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011272ssl_c_serial : binary
11273 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
11274 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11275 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011276
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011277ssl_c_sha1 : binary
11278 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
11279 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
11280 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020011281 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
11282 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
11283
11284 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011285
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011286ssl_c_sig_alg : string
11287 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
11288 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
11289 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011290
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011291ssl_c_used : boolean
11292 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
11293 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020011294
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011295ssl_c_verify : integer
11296 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
11297 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
11298 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
11299 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020011300
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011301ssl_c_version : integer
11302 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
11303 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020011304
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010011305ssl_f_der : binary
11306 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
11307 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11308 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
11309
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011310ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11311 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11312 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
11313 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11314 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011315 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011316 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11317 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11318 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011319
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011320ssl_f_key_alg : string
11321 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
11322 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
11323 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020011324
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011325ssl_f_notafter : string
11326 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
11327 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11328 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011329
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011330ssl_f_notbefore : string
11331 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
11332 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11333 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011334
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011335ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11336 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11337 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
11338 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11339 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
11340 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
11341 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11342 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11343 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020011344
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011345ssl_f_serial : binary
11346 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
11347 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11348 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011349
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020011350ssl_f_sha1 : binary
11351 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
11352 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
11353 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
11354
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011355ssl_f_sig_alg : string
11356 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
11357 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
11358 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020011359
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011360ssl_f_version : integer
11361 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
11362 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11363
11364ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011365 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
11366 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
11367 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
11368
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011369 Example :
11370 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
11371 listen http-https
11372 bind :80
11373 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
11374 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
11375
11376ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
11377 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
11378 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11379
11380ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011381 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011382 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
11383 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
11384 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
11385 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
11386 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
11387 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
11388 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
11389 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
11390
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011391ssl_fc_cipher : string
11392 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
11393 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011394
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011395ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011396 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
11397 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010011398 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
11399 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
11400 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
11401 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011402
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011403ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
11404 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020011405 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
11406 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
11407 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
11408 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020011409
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011410ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011411 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011412 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
11413 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
11414 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
11415 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
11416 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
11417 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
11418 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020011419
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011420ssl_fc_protocol : string
11421 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
11422 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020011423
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011424ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040011425 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011426 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
11427 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040011428
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011429ssl_fc_session_id : binary
11430 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
11431 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
11432 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
11433 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020011434
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011435ssl_fc_sni : string
11436 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
11437 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
11438 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
11439 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
11440 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
11441
11442 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
11443 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
11444 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020011445 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
11446 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011447
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011448 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011449 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
11450 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020011451
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011452ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
11453 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
11454 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020011455
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020011456
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200114577.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011458------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020011459
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011460Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
11461sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
11462only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
11463For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
11464be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
11465can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
11466sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
11467for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
11468content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011469
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011470payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
11471 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
11472 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
11473 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011474
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011475payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
11476 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
11477 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
11478 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011479
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011480req.len : integer
11481req_len : integer (deprecated)
11482 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
11483 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
11484 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
11485 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
11486 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
11487 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
11488 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
11489 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011490
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011491req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
11492 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020011493 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
11494 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
11495 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
11496 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011497
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011498 ACL alternatives :
11499 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011500
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011501req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
11502 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
11503 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
11504 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
11505 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011506
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011507 ACL alternatives :
11508 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011509
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011510 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011511
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011512req.proto_http : boolean
11513req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
11514 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
11515 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
11516 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
11517 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
11518 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
11519 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
11520 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011521
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011522 Example:
11523 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
11524 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
11525 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011526 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011527
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011528req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
11529rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11530 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
11531 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
11532 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
11533 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
11534 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
11535 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
11536 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011537
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011538 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
11539 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
11540 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
11541 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
11542 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
11543 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011544
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011545 ACL derivatives :
11546 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011547
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011548 Example :
11549 listen tse-farm
11550 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
11551 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
11552 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11553 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
11554 # apply RDP cookie persistence
11555 persist rdp-cookie
11556 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
11557 # This is only useful makes sense if
11558 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
11559 stick-table type string size 204800
11560 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
11561 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
11562 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011563
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011564 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
11565 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011566
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011567req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
11568rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
11569 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
11570 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
11571 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
11572 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011573
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011574 ACL derivatives :
11575 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011576
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011577req.ssl_hello_type : integer
11578req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
11579 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
11580 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
11581 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
11582 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
11583 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
11584 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
11585 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011586
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011587req.ssl_sni : string
11588req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
11589 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
11590 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
11591 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
11592 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
11593 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
11594 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
11595 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
11596 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
11597 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
11598 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
11599 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
11600 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011601
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011602 ACL derivatives :
11603 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011604
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011605 Examples :
11606 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
11607 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11608 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
11609 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
11610 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011611
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011612res.ssl_hello_type : integer
11613rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
11614 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
11615 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
11616 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
11617 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
11618 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
11619 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
11620 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +020011621
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011622req.ssl_ver : integer
11623req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
11624 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
11625 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
11626 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
11627 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
11628 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
11629 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
11630 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
11631 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
11632 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011633
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011634 ACL derivatives :
11635 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011636
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020011637res.len : integer
11638 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
11639 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
11640 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
11641 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
11642 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
11643 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
11644 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
11645 content inspection.
11646
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011647res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
11648 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020011649 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
11650 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
11651 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
11652 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011653
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011654res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
11655 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
11656 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
11657 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
11658 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011659
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011660 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011661
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011662wait_end : boolean
11663 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
11664 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
11665 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
11666 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
11667 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
11668 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
11669 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
11670 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011671
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011672 Examples :
11673 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
11674 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
11675 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011676
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011677 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
11678 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
11679 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
11680 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
11681 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
11682 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
11683 tcp-request content reject
11684
11685
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200116867.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011687--------------------------------------
11688
11689It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
11690This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
11691data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
11692its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
11693HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
11694content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
11695to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
11696more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
11697response are indexed.
11698
11699base : string
11700 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
11701 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
11702 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
11703 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
11704 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
11705 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
11706 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
11707 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
11708
11709 ACL derivatives :
11710 base : exact string match
11711 base_beg : prefix match
11712 base_dir : subdir match
11713 base_dom : domain match
11714 base_end : suffix match
11715 base_len : length match
11716 base_reg : regex match
11717 base_sub : substring match
11718
11719base32 : integer
11720 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
11721 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
11722 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011723 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
11724 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
11725 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011726
11727base32+src : binary
11728 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
11729 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
11730 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
11731 per-URL counters.
11732
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010011733capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
11734 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
11735 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
11736 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
11737
11738capture.req.method : string
11739 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
11740 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
11741 because it's allocated.
11742
11743capture.req.uri : string
11744 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
11745 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
11746 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
11747 allocated.
11748
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020011749capture.req.ver : string
11750 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
11751 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
11752 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
11753
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010011754capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
11755 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
11756 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
11757 The first entry is an index of 0.
11758 See also: "capture response header"
11759
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020011760capture.res.ver : string
11761 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
11762 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
11763 persistent flag.
11764
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011765req.cook([<name>]) : string
11766cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11767 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11768 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
11769 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
11770 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
11771 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
11772 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
11773 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
11774 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
11775
11776 ACL derivatives :
11777 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
11778 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
11779 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
11780 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
11781 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
11782 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
11783 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
11784 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011785
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011786req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11787cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11788 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
11789 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011790
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011791req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
11792cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11793 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11794 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
11795 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
11796 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011797
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011798cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11799 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11800 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
11801 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
11802 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
11803 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
11804 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
11805 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
11806 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
11807 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
11808 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011809
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011810hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11811 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
11812 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
11813 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
11814 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011815 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011816
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011817req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
11818 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
11819 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
11820 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11821 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11822 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11823 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
11824 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
11825 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011826
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011827req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11828 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
11829 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11830 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
11831 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011832
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011833req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11834 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
11835 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
11836 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11837 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11838 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11839 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
11840 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
11841 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
11842 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
11843 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
11844 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011845
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011846 ACL derivatives :
11847 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
11848 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
11849 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
11850 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
11851 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
11852 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
11853 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
11854 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
11855
11856req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11857hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
11858 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
11859 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
11860 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
11861 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
11862 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
11863 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
11864 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
11865 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
11866 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
11867
11868req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
11869hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
11870 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
11871 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
11872 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
11873 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
11874 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
11875 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11876 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
11877 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
11878
11879req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
11880hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
11881 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
11882 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
11883 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
11884 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11885 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11886 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11887 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
11888
11889http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
11890 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
11891 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
11892 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
11893 basic auth is supported.
11894
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010011895http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
11896 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
11897 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
11898 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
11899 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011900 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
11901 basic auth is supported.
11902
11903 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010011904 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
11905 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
11906 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
11907 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011908
11909http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020011910 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
11911 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011912 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
11913 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020011914
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011915method : integer + string
11916 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
11917 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
11918 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
11919 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
11920 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
11921 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
11922 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011923
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011924 ACL derivatives :
11925 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011926
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011927 Example :
11928 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
11929 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
11930 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011931
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011932path : string
11933 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
11934 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
11935 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
11936 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
11937 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
11938 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
11939 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011940
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011941 ACL derivatives :
11942 path : exact string match
11943 path_beg : prefix match
11944 path_dir : subdir match
11945 path_dom : domain match
11946 path_end : suffix match
11947 path_len : length match
11948 path_reg : regex match
11949 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011950
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010011951query : string
11952 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
11953 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
11954 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
11955 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
11956 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the completemnt of "path"
11957 which stops before the question mark.
11958
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011959req.ver : string
11960req_ver : string (deprecated)
11961 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
11962 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
11963 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011964
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011965 ACL derivatives :
11966 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011967
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011968res.comp : boolean
11969 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
11970 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
11971 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011972
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011973res.comp_algo : string
11974 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
11975 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
11976 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011977
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011978res.cook([<name>]) : string
11979scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11980 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11981 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
11982 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020011983
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011984 ACL derivatives :
11985 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020011986
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011987res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11988scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11989 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
11990 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
11991 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011992
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011993res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
11994scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11995 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11996 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
11997 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011998
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011999res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
12000 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
12001 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
12002 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
12003 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
12004 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
12005 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
12006 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
12007 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
12008 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012009
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012010res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12011 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
12012 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
12013 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
12014 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
12015 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012016
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012017res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
12018shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
12019 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
12020 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
12021 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
12022 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
12023 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
12024 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
12025 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
12026 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012027
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012028 ACL derivatives :
12029 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
12030 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
12031 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
12032 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
12033 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
12034 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
12035 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
12036 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
12037
12038res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12039shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12040 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
12041 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
12042 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
12043 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
12044 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012045
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012046res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
12047shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
12048 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
12049 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
12050 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
12051 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
12052 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
12053 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012054
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012055res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
12056shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
12057 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
12058 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
12059 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
12060 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
12061 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
12062 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010012063
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012064res.ver : string
12065resp_ver : string (deprecated)
12066 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
12067 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020012068
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012069 ACL derivatives :
12070 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010012071
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012072set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12073 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
12074 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
12075 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
12076 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010012077
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012078 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
12079 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010012080
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012081 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012082
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012083status : integer
12084 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
12085 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
12086 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012087
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012088url : string
12089 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
12090 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
12091 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
12092 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
12093 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
12094 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
12095 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012096
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012097 ACL derivatives :
12098 url : exact string match
12099 url_beg : prefix match
12100 url_dir : subdir match
12101 url_dom : domain match
12102 url_end : suffix match
12103 url_len : length match
12104 url_reg : regex match
12105 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012106
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012107url_ip : ip
12108 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
12109 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
12110 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
12111 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
12112 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
12113 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
12114 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012115
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012116url_port : integer
12117 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
12118 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
12119 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
12120 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012121
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012122urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
12123url_param(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
12124 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
12125 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
12126 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. The result is a string
12127 corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in the
12128 request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
12129 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
12130 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
12131 this fetch do not iterate over multiple parameters and stop at the first one
12132 as well.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012133
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012134 ACL derivatives :
12135 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
12136 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
12137 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
12138 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
12139 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
12140 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
12141 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
12142 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012143
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012144
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012145 Example :
12146 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
12147 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
12148 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
12149 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012150
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012151urlp_val(<name>[,<delim>]) : integer
12152 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
12153 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
12154 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020012155
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010012156
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200121577.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012158---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010012159
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012160Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
12161every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012162order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010012163
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012164ACL name Equivalent to Usage
12165---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012166FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020012167HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012168HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
12169HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012170HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
12171HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
12172HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
12173HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
12174LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012175METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
12176METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
12177METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
12178METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
12179METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
12180METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020012181RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012182REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012183TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012184WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
12185---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010012186
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012187
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121888. Logging
12189----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012190
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012191One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
12192provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
12193very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
12194provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
12195state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012196to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012197headers.
12198
12199In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
12200about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
12201send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
12202
12203 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
12204 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
12205 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
12206 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
12207 at the termination.
12208
12209The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
12210allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
12211as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
12212while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
12213real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
12214delay.
12215
12216
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122178.1. Log levels
12218---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012219
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090012220TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012221source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090012222HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
12223in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
12224track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
12225syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
12226about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012227
12228
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122298.2. Log formats
12230----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012231
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012232HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090012233and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
12234slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
12235options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012236
12237 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
12238 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
12239 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
12240 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
12241 extents.
12242
12243 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
12244 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
12245 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
12246 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
12247 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
12248
12249 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
12250 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
12251 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
12252 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
12253 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
12254
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020012255 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
12256 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
12257 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
12258 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
12259
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012260 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
12261
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012262Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
12263specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
12264field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
12265servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
12266always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
12267identifier.
12268
12269Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
12270 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
12271 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
12272 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
12273 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
12274
12275
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122768.2.1. Default log format
12277-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012278
12279This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
12280as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
12281format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
12282
12283 Example :
12284 listen www
12285 mode http
12286 log global
12287 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
12288
12289 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
12290 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
12291 (www/HTTP)
12292
12293 Field Format Extract from the example above
12294 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
12295 2 'Connect from' Connect from
12296 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
12297 4 'to' to
12298 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
12299 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
12300
12301Detailed fields description :
12302 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
12303 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
12304 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
12305 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
12306 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
12307 and processed the connection.
12308 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
12309
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012310In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
12311"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
12312connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
12313
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012314It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
12315will eventually disappear.
12316
12317
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123188.2.2. TCP log format
12319---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012320
12321The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
12322is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
12323information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
12324counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
12325emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
12326environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
12327the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
12328sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012329specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
12330not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
12331fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
12332marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012333
12334 Example :
12335 frontend fnt
12336 mode tcp
12337 option tcplog
12338 log global
12339 default_backend bck
12340
12341 backend bck
12342 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
12343
12344 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
12345 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
12346 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
12347
12348 Field Format Extract from the example above
12349 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
12350 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
12351 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
12352 4 frontend_name fnt
12353 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
12354 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
12355 7 bytes_read* 212
12356 8 termination_state --
12357 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
12358 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
12359
12360Detailed fields description :
12361 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012362 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
12363 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
12364 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
12365 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
12366 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012367
12368 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012369 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
12370 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
12371 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012372
12373 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
12374 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
12375 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
12376 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
12377
12378 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
12379 and processed the connection.
12380
12381 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
12382 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
12383 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
12384 applications.
12385
12386 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
12387 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
12388 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
12389 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
12390 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
12391
12392 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
12393 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
12394 See "Timers" below for more details.
12395
12396 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
12397 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
12398 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
12399 "Timers" below for more details.
12400
12401 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012402 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012403 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
12404 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
12405 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
12406 details.
12407
12408 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
12409 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
12410 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
12411 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
12412 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
12413
12414 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
12415 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
12416 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
12417 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
12418 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
12419 for more details.
12420
12421 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012422 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012423 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
12424 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
12425 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012426 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012427
12428 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
12429 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
12430 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
12431 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
12432 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
12433 caused by a denial of service attack.
12434
12435 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
12436 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
12437 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
12438 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
12439 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
12440 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
12441 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
12442 denial of service attack.
12443
12444 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
12445 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
12446 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
12447 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
12448 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
12449 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
12450 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
12451 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
12452 be processed than on other servers.
12453
12454 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
12455 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
12456 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
12457 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
12458 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
12459 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
12460 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
12461 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
12462 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
12463 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
12464 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
12465 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
12466 should not be attributed to the logged server.
12467
12468 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12469 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
12470 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
12471 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
12472 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
12473 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
12474 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
12475 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
12476
12477 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12478 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
12479 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
12480 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
12481 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
12482 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
12483 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
12484 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
12485 occurs.
12486
12487
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124888.2.3. HTTP log format
12489----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012490
12491The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
12492is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
12493the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
12494are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
12495emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
12496generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
12497"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
12498which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012499frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
12500is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012501
12502Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
12503slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
12504with a star ('*') after the field name below.
12505
12506 Example :
12507 frontend http-in
12508 mode http
12509 option httplog
12510 log global
12511 default_backend bck
12512
12513 backend static
12514 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
12515
12516 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
12517 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
12518 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012519 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012520
12521 Field Format Extract from the example above
12522 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
12523 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
12524 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
12525 4 frontend_name http-in
12526 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
12527 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
12528 7 status_code 200
12529 8 bytes_read* 2750
12530 9 captured_request_cookie -
12531 10 captured_response_cookie -
12532 11 termination_state ----
12533 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
12534 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
12535 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
12536 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
12537 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012538
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012539
12540Detailed fields description :
12541 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012542 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
12543 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
12544 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
12545 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
12546 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012547
12548 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012549 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
12550 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
12551 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012552
12553 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
12554 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
12555 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
12556 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
12557 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
12558
12559 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
12560 and processed the connection.
12561
12562 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
12563 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
12564 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
12565
12566 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
12567 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
12568 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
12569 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
12570 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
12571 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
12572
12573 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
12574 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
12575 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
12576 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
12577 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
12578 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
12579
12580 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
12581 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
12582 See "Timers" below for more details.
12583
12584 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
12585 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
12586 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
12587 below for more details.
12588
12589 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
12590 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
12591 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
12592 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
12593 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
12594 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
12595 for more details.
12596
12597 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012598 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012599 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
12600 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
12601 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
12602 details.
12603
12604 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
12605 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
12606 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
12607
12608 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
12609 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
12610 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
12611 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
12612 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
12613 overflowing.
12614
12615 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
12616 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
12617 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
12618 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
12619 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
12620 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
12621 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
12622 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
12623
12624 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
12625 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
12626 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
12627 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
12628 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
12629 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
12630 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
12631 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
12632
12633 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
12634 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
12635 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
12636 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
12637 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
12638 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
12639 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
12640
12641 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012642 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012643 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
12644 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
12645 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012646 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012647 system.
12648
12649 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
12650 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
12651 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
12652 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
12653 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
12654 caused by a denial of service attack.
12655
12656 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
12657 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
12658 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
12659 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
12660 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
12661 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
12662 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
12663 denial of service attack.
12664
12665 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
12666 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
12667 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
12668 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
12669 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
12670 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
12671 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
12672 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
12673 processed than on other servers.
12674
12675 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
12676 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
12677 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
12678 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
12679 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
12680 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
12681 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
12682 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
12683 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
12684 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
12685 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
12686 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
12687 should not be attributed to the logged server.
12688
12689 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12690 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
12691 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
12692 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
12693 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
12694 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
12695 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
12696 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
12697
12698 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12699 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
12700 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
12701 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
12702 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
12703 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
12704 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
12705 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
12706 occurs.
12707
12708 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
12709 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
12710 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
12711 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
12712 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
12713 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
12714 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
12715 cookies" below for more details.
12716
12717 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
12718 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
12719 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
12720 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
12721 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
12722 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
12723 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
12724 and cookies" below for more details.
12725
12726 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
12727 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
12728 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
12729 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
12730 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
12731 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
12732 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
12733 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
12734
12735
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200127368.2.4. Custom log format
12737------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012738
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012739The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012740mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012741
12742HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
12743Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
12744separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
12745prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
12746
12747Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
12748variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
12749string formats ("Q").
12750
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010012751If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012752as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010012753less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
12754the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
12755
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012756Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012757In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010012758in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012759
12760Flags are :
12761 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012762 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012763
12764 Example:
12765
12766 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
12767 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
12768
12769At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
12770
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012771 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
12772 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012773
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012774the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012775
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012776 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020012777 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012778 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012779
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012780and the default TCP format is defined this way :
12781
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012782 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012783 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
12784
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012785Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
12786
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012787 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012788 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012789 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
12790 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
12791 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012792 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
12793 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
12794 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012795 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012796 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020012797 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012798 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012799 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080012800 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012801 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
12802 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012803 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012804 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
12805 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012806 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012807 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
12808 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012809 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
12810 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
12811 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012812 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012813 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
12814 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012815 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012816 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
12817 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
12818 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020012819 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020012820 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020012821 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
12822 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
12823 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
12824 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012825 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012826 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012827 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012828 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010012829 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012830 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012831 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
12832 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
12833 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012834 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012835 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
12836 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012837 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012838 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012839 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012840 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012841
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012842 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012843
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010012844
128458.2.5. Error log format
12846-----------------------
12847
12848When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
12849protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
12850By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
12851"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
12852will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
12853logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
12854
12855The format looks like this :
12856
12857 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
12858 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
12859 Connection error during SSL handshake
12860
12861 Field Format Extract from the example above
12862 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
12863 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
12864 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
12865 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
12866 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
12867
12868These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
12869failures.
12870
12871
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128728.3. Advanced logging options
12873-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012874
12875Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
12876just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
12877options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
12878for more information about their usage.
12879
12880
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128818.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
12882------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012883
12884It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
12885haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
12886commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
12887monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
12888ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
12889
12890 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
12891 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
12892 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
12893 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
12894
12895 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
12896 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
12897 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012898 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012899 such as other load-balancers.
12900
12901 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
12902 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
12903 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
12904
12905
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129068.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
12907----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012908
12909The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
12910what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
12911or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
12912"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
12913just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
12914log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
12915after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
12916is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
12917with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
12918with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
12919
12920
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129218.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
12922------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012923
12924Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
12925for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
12926"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
12927retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
12928raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
12929a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
12930file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
12931you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
12932"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
12933
12934
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129358.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
12936--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012937
12938Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
12939multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
12940them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
12941"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
12942logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
12943error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
12944and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
12945too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
12946useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
12947alternative.
12948
12949
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129508.4. Timing events
12951------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012952
12953Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
12954reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
12955the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
12956frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
12957mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
12958
12959 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
12960 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
12961 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
12962 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
12963 the client closes prematurely or times out.
12964
12965 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
12966 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
12967 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
12968 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
12969 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
12970
12971 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
12972 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
12973 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
12974 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
12975 connection never established.
12976
12977 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
12978 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
12979 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
12980 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
12981 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
12982 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
12983 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
12984 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
12985 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
12986 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
12987 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
12988
12989 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
12990 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
12991 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
12992 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012993 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012994
12995 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
12996
12997 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
12998 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
12999 negative.
13000
13001These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
13002protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
13003that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013004due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013005close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
13006session has been aborted on timeout.
13007
13008Most common cases :
13009
13010 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
13011 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
13012 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
13013 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
13014 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
13015 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
13016 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
13017 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
13018 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020013019 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
13020 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
13021 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013022
13023 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
13024 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
13025 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
13026 of ms on remote networks.
13027
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013028 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
13029 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
13030 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013031
13032 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
13033 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
13034 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
13035 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
13036 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
13037 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
13038 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
13039 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
13040 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
13041 to the server until another one is released.
13042
13043Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
13044
13045 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
13046 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
13047 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
13048
13049 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
13050 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
13051 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
13052
13053 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
13054 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
13055 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
13056 flags.
13057
13058 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
13059 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
13060 Check the session termination flags, then check the
13061 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
13062 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
13063 the client connection was maintained open.
13064
13065 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013066 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013067 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
13068 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
13069
13070
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200130718.5. Session state at disconnection
13072-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013073
13074TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
13075"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
130762-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
13077each of which has a special meaning :
13078
13079 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
13080 session to terminate :
13081
13082 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
13083
13084 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
13085 server explicitly refused it.
13086
13087 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
13088 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
13089 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
13090 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020013091 (eg: cacheable cookie).
13092
13093 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
13094 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013095
13096 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
13097 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
13098 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
13099 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
13100 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
13101
13102 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
13103 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
13104 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
13105 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
13106 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
13107
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090013108 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
13109 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
13110
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013111 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
13112 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
13113 backup connections when going up.
13114
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020013115 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
13116
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013117 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
13118 send or receive data.
13119
13120 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
13121 send or receive data.
13122
13123 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
13124 with nothing left in the buffers.
13125
13126 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
13127
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010013128 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013129 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
13130
13131 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
13132 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
13133 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
13134 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
13135 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
13136
13137 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
13138 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
13139
13140 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
13141 server (HTTP only).
13142
13143 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
13144
13145 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
13146 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
13147 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
13148
13149 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
13150 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
13151 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
13152
13153 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
13154
13155 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
13156 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
13157
13158 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
13159 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
13160 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
13161
13162 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
13163 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020013164 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
13165 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013166
13167 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
13168 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
13169 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
13170 another server.
13171
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013172 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013173 server.
13174
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013175 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
13176 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
13177 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
13178 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
13179
13180 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
13181 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
13182 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
13183 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
13184
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020013185 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
13186 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
13187 "use-server" rule).
13188
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013189 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
13190
13191 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
13192 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
13193
13194 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
13195
13196 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
13197 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
13198 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
13199
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013200 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
13201 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013202 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013203 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
13204 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
13205
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013206 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
13207
13208 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
13209 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
13210
13211 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
13212
13213 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
13214
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013215The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
13216was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013217helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
13218starvation, attacks, etc...
13219
13220The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
13221alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
13222easier finding and understanding.
13223
13224 Flags Reason
13225
13226 -- Normal termination.
13227
13228 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
13229 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
13230 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
13231 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
13232
13233 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
13234 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
13235 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
13236 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
13237 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
13238 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013239
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013240 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
13241 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020013242 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013243
13244 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
13245 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
13246 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
13247
13248 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
13249 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
13250 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
13251 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
13252 the server takes too long to respond.
13253
13254 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
13255 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
13256 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
13257 long a time to respond.
13258
13259 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
13260 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
13261 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
13262 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
13263 and the client.
13264
13265 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
13266 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
13267 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
13268 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
13269 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020013270 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
13271 some browsers such as Google Chrome started to break the deployed Web
13272 infrastructure by aggressively implementing a new "pre-connect"
13273 feature, consisting in sending connections to sites recently visited
13274 without sending any request on them until the user starts to browse
13275 the site. This mechanism causes massive disruption among resource-
13276 limited servers, and causes a lot of 408 errors in HAProxy logs.
13277 Worse, some people report that sometimes the browser displays the 408
13278 error when the user expects to see the actual content (Mozilla fixed
13279 this bug in 2004, while Chrome users continue to report it in 2014),
13280 so in this case, using "errorfile 408 /dev/null" can be used as a
13281 workaround. More information on the subject is available here :
13282 https://bugzilla.mozilla.org/show_bug.cgi?id=248827
13283 https://code.google.com/p/chromium/issues/detail?id=85229
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013284
13285 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
13286 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013287 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
13288 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
13289 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
13290 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013291
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020013292 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
13293 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
13294
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013295 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013296 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
13297 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
13298 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
13299 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
13300 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
13301
13302 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
13303 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
13304 503 or 504 here.
13305
13306 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
13307 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
13308 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
13309 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
13310 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
13311
13312 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
13313 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013314 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013315 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
13316 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
13317
13318 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
13319 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
13320 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
13321 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
13322 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
13323 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
13324 between haproxy and the server.
13325
13326 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
13327 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
13328 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
13329 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
13330 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
13331 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
13332 solution is to fix the application.
13333
13334 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
13335 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
13336 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
13337 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
13338 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
13339 external attacks.
13340
13341 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
13342 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020013343 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013344 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
13345 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
13346
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010013347 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
13348 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
13349 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020013350 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
13351 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010013352
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013353 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
13354 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
13355 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
13356 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010013357 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
13358 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
13359 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
13360 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
13361 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013362
13363 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
13364 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
13365 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
13366 returned an HTTP 403 error.
13367
13368 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
13369 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
13370 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
13371 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
13372
13373 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
13374 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
13375 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
13376 only be solved by proper system tuning.
13377
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013378The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
13379persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
13380important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
13381re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
13382
13383 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
13384
13385 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
13386 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
13387 set on a GET request.
13388
13389 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
13390 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013391 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013392 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
13393
13394 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
13395 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
13396 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
13397
13398 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
13399 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
13400 already got a cookie.
13401
13402 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
13403 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
13404 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
13405 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
13406 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
13407
13408 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
13409 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
13410 new cookie was inserted in the response.
13411
13412 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
13413 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
13414 new cookie was inserted in the response.
13415
13416 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
13417 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
13418
13419 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
13420 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
13421 then advertised in the response.
13422
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013423
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200134248.6. Non-printable characters
13425-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013426
13427In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
13428consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
13429converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
13430prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
13431being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
13432escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
13433is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
13434'}' when logging headers.
13435
13436Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
13437issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
13438containing spaces is "User-Agent".
13439
13440Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
13441the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
13442performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
13443
13444
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200134458.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
13446---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013447
13448Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
13449achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013450section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013451cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
13452the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
13453the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013454locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013455not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
13456user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
13457a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
13458wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
13459
13460 Examples :
13461 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
13462 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
13463
13464 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
13465 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
13466
13467
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200134688.8. Capturing HTTP headers
13469---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013470
13471Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
13472proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
13473the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
13474server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
13475
13476Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
13477response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013478section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013479
13480It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013481time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
13482appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013483are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
13484and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
13485follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
13486request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
13487in the logs.
13488
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020013489As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
13490frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
13491an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
13492
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013493 Example :
13494 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
13495 listen proxy-out
13496 mode http
13497 option httplog
13498 option logasap
13499 log global
13500 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
13501
13502 # log the name of the virtual server
13503 capture request header Host len 20
13504
13505 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
13506 capture request header Content-Length len 10
13507
13508 # log the beginning of the referrer
13509 capture request header Referer len 20
13510
13511 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
13512 capture response header Server len 20
13513
13514 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
13515 capture response header Content-Length len 10
13516
13517 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
13518 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
13519
13520 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
13521 capture response header Via len 20
13522
13523 # log the URL location during a redirection
13524 capture response header Location len 20
13525
13526 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
13527 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
13528 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13529 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
13530 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
13531
13532 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
13533 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
13534 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13535 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013536 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013537
13538 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
13539 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
13540 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13541 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
13542 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013543 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013544
13545
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200135468.9. Examples of logs
13547---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013548
13549These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
13550them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
13551reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
13552
13553 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
13554 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
13555 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
13556
13557 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
13558 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
13559
13560 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
13561 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
13562 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
13563
13564 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
13565 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
13566
13567 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
13568 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
13569 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
13570
13571 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013572 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013573 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
13574 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
13575
13576 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
13577 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
13578 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
13579
13580 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
13581 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020013582 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013583 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
13584 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
13585 to return the 502 and not the server.
13586
13587 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013588 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013589
13590 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
13591 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
13592 Nothing was sent to any server.
13593
13594 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
13595 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
13596
13597 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
13598 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
13599 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
13600 send a 408 return code to the client.
13601
13602 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
13603 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
13604
13605 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
13606 5 seconds ("c----").
13607
13608 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
13609 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013610 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013611
13612 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013613 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013614 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
13615 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
13616 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
13617 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
13618 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013619
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013620
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200136219. Statistics and monitoring
13622----------------------------
13623
13624It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
13625mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
13626CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
13627Unix socket.
13628
13629
136309.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013631---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010013632
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010013633The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
Willy Tarreaua3310dc2014-06-16 15:43:21 +020013634page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow. The first line
13635begins with a sharp ('#') and has one word per comma-delimited field which
13636represents the title of the column. All other lines starting at the second one
13637use a classical CSV format using a comma as the delimiter, and the double quote
13638('"') as an optional text delimiter, but only if the enclosed text is ambiguous
13639(if it contains a quote or a comma). The double-quote character ('"') in the
13640text is doubled ('""'), which is the format that most tools recognize. Please
13641do not insert any column before these ones in order not to break tools which
13642use hard-coded column positions.
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010013643
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040013644In brackets after each field name are the types which may have a value for
13645that field. The types are L (Listeners), F (Frontends), B (Backends), and
13646S (Servers).
13647
13648 0. pxname [LFBS]: proxy name
13649 1. svname [LFBS]: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend,
13650 any name for server/listener)
13651 2. qcur [..BS]: current queued requests. For the backend this reports the
13652 number queued without a server assigned.
13653 3. qmax [..BS]: max value of qcur
13654 4. scur [LFBS]: current sessions
13655 5. smax [LFBS]: max sessions
13656 6. slim [LFBS]: configured session limit
13657 7. stot [LFBS]: cumulative number of connections
13658 8. bin [LFBS]: bytes in
13659 9. bout [LFBS]: bytes out
13660 10. dreq [LFB.]: requests denied because of security concerns.
13661 - For tcp this is because of a matched tcp-request content rule.
13662 - For http this is because of a matched http-request or tarpit rule.
13663 11. dresp [LFBS]: responses denied because of security concerns.
13664 - For http this is because of a matched http-request rule, or
13665 "option checkcache".
13666 12. ereq [LF..]: request errors. Some of the possible causes are:
13667 - early termination from the client, before the request has been sent.
13668 - read error from the client
13669 - client timeout
13670 - client closed connection
13671 - various bad requests from the client.
13672 - request was tarpitted.
13673 13. econ [..BS]: number of requests that encountered an error trying to
13674 connect to a backend server. The backend stat is the sum of the stat
13675 for all servers of that backend, plus any connection errors not
13676 associated with a particular server (such as the backend having no
13677 active servers).
13678 14. eresp [..BS]: response errors. srv_abrt will be counted here also.
13679 Some other errors are:
13680 - write error on the client socket (won't be counted for the server stat)
13681 - failure applying filters to the response.
13682 15. wretr [..BS]: number of times a connection to a server was retried.
13683 16. wredis [..BS]: number of times a request was redispatched to another
13684 server. The server value counts the number of times that server was
13685 switched away from.
13686 17. status [LFBS]: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
13687 18. weight [..BS]: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
13688 19. act [..BS]: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
13689 20. bck [..BS]: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
13690 21. chkfail [...S]: number of failed checks. (Only counts checks failed when
13691 the server is up.)
13692 22. chkdown [..BS]: number of UP->DOWN transitions. The backend counter counts
13693 transitions to the whole backend being down, rather than the sum of the
13694 counters for each server.
13695 23. lastchg [..BS]: number of seconds since the last UP<->DOWN transition
13696 24. downtime [..BS]: total downtime (in seconds). The value for the backend
13697 is the downtime for the whole backend, not the sum of the server downtime.
13698 25. qlimit [...S]: configured maxqueue for the server, or nothing in the
13699 value is 0 (default, meaning no limit)
13700 26. pid [LFBS]: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
13701 27. iid [LFBS]: unique proxy id
13702 28. sid [L..S]: server id (unique inside a proxy)
13703 29. throttle [...S]: current throttle percentage for the server, when
13704 slowstart is active, or no value if not in slowstart.
13705 30. lbtot [..BS]: total number of times a server was selected, either for new
13706 sessions, or when re-dispatching. The server counter is the number
13707 of times that server was selected.
13708 31. tracked [...S]: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled.
13709 32. type [LFBS]: (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket/listener)
13710 33. rate [.FBS]: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
13711 34. rate_lim [.F..]: configured limit on new sessions per second
13712 35. rate_max [.FBS]: max number of new sessions per second
13713 36. check_status [...S]: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013714 UNK -> unknown
13715 INI -> initializing
13716 SOCKERR -> socket error
13717 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
13718 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
13719 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
13720 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
13721 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
13722 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
13723 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
13724 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
13725 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
13726 disable-on-404
13727 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
13728 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
13729 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040013730 37. check_code [...S]: layer5-7 code, if available
13731 38. check_duration [...S]: time in ms took to finish last health check
13732 39. hrsp_1xx [.FBS]: http responses with 1xx code
13733 40. hrsp_2xx [.FBS]: http responses with 2xx code
13734 41. hrsp_3xx [.FBS]: http responses with 3xx code
13735 42. hrsp_4xx [.FBS]: http responses with 4xx code
13736 43. hrsp_5xx [.FBS]: http responses with 5xx code
13737 44. hrsp_other [.FBS]: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
13738 45. hanafail [...S]: failed health checks details
13739 46. req_rate [.F..]: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
13740 47. req_rate_max [.F..]: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
13741 48. req_tot [.F..]: total number of HTTP requests received
13742 49. cli_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the client
13743 50. srv_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the server
13744 (inc. in eresp)
13745 51. comp_in [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
13746 52. comp_out [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
13747 53. comp_byp [.FB.]: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor
13748 (CPU/BW limit)
13749 54. comp_rsp [.FB.]: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
13750 55. lastsess [..BS]: number of seconds since last session assigned to
13751 server/backend
13752 56. last_chk [...S]: last health check contents or textual error
13753 57. last_agt [...S]: last agent check contents or textual error
13754 58. qtime [..BS]: the average queue time in ms over the 1024 last requests
13755 59. ctime [..BS]: the average connect time in ms over the 1024 last requests
13756 60. rtime [..BS]: the average response time in ms over the 1024 last requests
13757 (0 for TCP)
13758 61. ttime [..BS]: the average total session time in ms over the 1024 last
13759 requests
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013760
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013761
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137629.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013763-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013764
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020013765The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
13766necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
13767A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
13768issuing commands by hand :
13769
13770 global
13771 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
13772 stats timeout 2m
13773
13774It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
13775the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
13776never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
13777situations :
13778
13779 global
13780 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
13781 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
13782 stats timeout 2m
13783
13784To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
13785swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
13786to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
13787syntaxes we'll use are the following :
13788
13789 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
13790 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
13791
13792The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
13793script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
13794for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
13795
13796The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
13797that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
13798editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
13799(eg: watch a counter).
13800
13801The socket supports two operation modes :
13802 - interactive
13803 - non-interactive
13804
13805The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
13806this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
13807sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
13808mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
13809commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
13810example :
13811
13812 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
13813
13814The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
13815entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
13816for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
13817sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
13818"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
13819after processing the last command of the same line.
13820
13821For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
13822"prompt" command :
13823
13824 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
13825 prompt
13826 > show info
13827 ...
13828 >
13829
13830Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
13831delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
13832that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
13833parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013834
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013835It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
13836on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
13837own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013838
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020013839The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
13840If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
13841all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
13842it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
13843
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013844add acl <acl> <pattern>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013845 Add an entry into the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by
13846 "show acl". This command does not verify if the entry already exists. This
13847 command cannot be used if the reference <acl> is a file also used with a map.
13848 In this case, you must use the command "add map" in place of "add acl".
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013849
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013850add map <map> <key> <value>
13851 Add an entry into the map <map> to associate the value <value> to the key
13852 <key>. This command does not verify if the entry already exists. It is
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013853 mainly used to fill a map after a clear operation. Note that if the reference
13854 <map> is a file and is shared with a map, this map will contain also a new
13855 pattern entry.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013856
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013857clear counters
13858 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
13859 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
13860 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
13861 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
13862 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
13863
13864clear counters all
13865 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
13866 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
13867 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
13868
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013869clear acl <acl>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013870 Remove all entries from the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file>
13871 returned by "show acl". Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and is
13872 shared with a map, this map will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013873
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013874clear map <map>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013875 Remove all entries from the map <map>. <map> is the #<id> or the <file>
13876 returned by "show map". Note that if the reference <map> is a file and is
13877 shared with a acl, this acl will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013878
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013879clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
13880 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
13881
13882 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
13883 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
13884 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
13885 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
13886 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
13887 later after the session ends is usual enough.
13888
13889 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
13890
13891 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
13892 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
13893 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
13894 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
13895 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
13896 the ACLs :
13897
13898 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
13899 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
13900 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
13901 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
13902 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
13903 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
13904
13905 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090013906 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
13907 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013908
13909 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013910 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020013911 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013912 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
13913 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
13914 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13915 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013916
13917 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13918
13919 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020013920 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013921 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13922 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013923 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13924 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13925 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013926
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013927del acl <acl> [<key>|#<ref>]
13928 Delete all the acl entries from the acl <acl> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013929 <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show acl". If the <ref> is used,
13930 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
13931 listing the content of the acl. Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and
13932 is shared with a map, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013933
13934del map <map> [<key>|#<ref>]
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010013935 Delete all the map entries from the map <map> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013936 <map> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used,
13937 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
13938 listing the content of the map. Note that if the reference <map> is a file and
13939 is shared with a acl, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010013940
13941disable agent <backend>/<server>
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090013942 Mark the auxiliary agent check as temporarily stopped.
13943
13944 In the case where an agent check is being run as a auxiliary check, due
13945 to the agent-check parameter of a server directive, new checks are only
13946 initialised when the agent is in the enabled. Thus, disable agent will
13947 prevent any new agent checks from begin initiated until the agent
13948 re-enabled using enable agent.
13949
13950 When an agent is disabled the processing of an auxiliary agent check that
13951 was initiated while the agent was set as enabled is as follows: All
13952 results that would alter the weight, specifically "drain" or a weight
13953 returned by the agent, are ignored. The processing of agent check is
13954 otherwise unchanged.
13955
13956 The motivation for this feature is to allow the weight changing effects
13957 of the agent checks to be paused to allow the weight of a server to be
13958 configured using set weight without being overridden by the agent.
13959
13960 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13961 level "admin".
13962
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013963disable frontend <frontend>
13964 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
13965 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
13966 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
13967 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
13968 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
13969 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
13970 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
13971 on the stats page.
13972
13973 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13974 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13975
13976 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13977 level "admin".
13978
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020013979disable health <backend>/<server>
13980 Mark the primary health check as temporarily stopped. This will disable
13981 sending of health checks, and the last health check result will be ignored.
13982 The server will be in unchecked state and considered UP unless an auxiliary
13983 agent check forces it down.
13984
13985 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13986 level "admin".
13987
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013988disable server <backend>/<server>
13989 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
13990 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
13991 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
13992 during the maintenance.
13993
13994 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
13995 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
13996
13997 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013998 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013999
14000 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14001 level "admin".
14002
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090014003enable agent <backend>/<server>
14004 Resume auxiliary agent check that was temporarily stopped.
14005
14006 See "disable agent" for details of the effect of temporarily starting
14007 and stopping an auxiliary agent.
14008
14009 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14010 level "admin".
14011
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020014012enable frontend <frontend>
14013 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
14014 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
14015 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
14016 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
14017 which was disabled.
14018
14019 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
14020 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
14021
14022 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14023 level "admin".
14024
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020014025enable health <backend>/<server>
14026 Resume a primary health check that was temporarily stopped. This will enable
14027 sending of health checks again. Please see "disable health" for details.
14028
14029 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14030 level "admin".
14031
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014032enable server <backend>/<server>
14033 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
14034 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
14035
14036 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020014037 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014038
14039 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14040 level "admin".
14041
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010014042get map <map> <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014043get acl <acl> <value>
14044 Lookup the value <value> in the map <map> or in the ACL <acl>. <map> or <acl>
14045 are the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map" or "show acl". This command
14046 returns all the matching patterns associated with this map. This is useful for
14047 debugging maps and ACLs. The output format is composed by one line par
14048 matching type. Each line is composed by space-delimited series of words.
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010014049
14050 The first two words are:
14051
14052 <match method>: The match method applied. It can be "found", "bool",
14053 "int", "ip", "bin", "len", "str", "beg", "sub", "dir",
14054 "dom", "end" or "reg".
14055
14056 <match result>: The result. Can be "match" or "no-match".
14057
14058 The following words are returned only if the pattern matches an entry.
14059
14060 <index type>: "tree" or "list". The internal lookup algorithm.
14061
14062 <case>: "case-insensitive" or "case-sensitive". The
14063 interpretation of the case.
14064
14065 <entry matched>: match="<entry>". Return the matched pattern. It is
14066 useful with regular expressions.
14067
14068 The two last word are used to show the returned value and its type. With the
14069 "acl" case, the pattern doesn't exist.
14070
14071 return=nothing: No return because there are no "map".
14072 return="<value>": The value returned in the string format.
14073 return=cannot-display: The value cannot be converted as string.
14074
14075 type="<type>": The type of the returned sample.
14076
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014077get weight <backend>/<server>
14078 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
14079 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
14080 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
14081 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
14082 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020014083 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014084
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014085help
14086 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
14087 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014088
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014089prompt
14090 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
14091 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
14092 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
14093 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
14094 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
14095 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
14096 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
14097 command.
14098
14099quit
14100 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010014101
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014102set map <map> [<key>|#<ref>] <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014103 Modify the value corresponding to each key <key> in a map <map>. <map> is the
14104 #<id> or <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used in place of
14105 <key>, only the entry pointed by <ref> is changed. The new value is <value>.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014106
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020014107set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020014108 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
14109 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
14110 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
14111 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
14112 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020014113 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
14114 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
14115
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020014116set maxconn global <maxconn>
14117 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
14118 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
14119 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
14120 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
14121 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
14122 setting.
14123
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020014124set rate-limit connections global <value>
14125 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
14126 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
14127 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
14128 is passed in number of connections per second.
14129
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010014130set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
14131 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
14132 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010014133 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
14134 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010014135
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +020014136set rate-limit sessions global <value>
14137 Change the process-wide session rate limit, which is set by the global
14138 'maxsessrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
14139 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
14140 is passed in number of sessions per second.
14141
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +020014142set rate-limit ssl-sessions global <value>
14143 Change the process-wide SSL session rate limit, which is set by the global
14144 'maxsslrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
14145 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
14146 is passed in number of sessions per second sent to the SSL stack. It applies
14147 before the handshake in order to protect the stack against handshake abuses.
14148
Willy Tarreau2a4b70f2014-05-22 18:42:35 +020014149set server <backend>/<server> agent [ up | down ]
14150 Force a server's agent to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
14151 switch a server's state regardless of some slow agent checks for example.
14152 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
14153
14154set server <backend>/<server> health [ up | stopping | down ]
14155 Force a server's health to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
14156 switch a server's state regardless of some slow health checks for example.
14157 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
14158
14159set server <backend>/<server> state [ ready | drain | maint ]
14160 Force a server's administrative state to a new state. This can be useful to
14161 disable load balancing and/or any traffic to a server. Setting the state to
14162 "ready" puts the server in normal mode, and the command is the equivalent of
14163 the "enable server" command. Setting the state to "maint" disables any traffic
14164 to the server as well as any health checks. This is the equivalent of the
14165 "disable server" command. Setting the mode to "drain" only removes the server
14166 from load balancing but still allows it to be checked and to accept new
14167 persistent connections. Changes are propagated to tracking servers if any.
14168
14169set server <backend>/<server> weight <weight>[%]
14170 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. This is the exact
14171 equivalent of the "set weight" command below.
14172
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020014173set ssl ocsp-response <response>
14174 This command is used to update an OCSP Response for a certificate (see "crt"
14175 on "bind" lines). Same controls are performed as during the initial loading of
14176 the response. The <response> must be passed as a base64 encoded string of the
14177 DER encoded response from the OCSP server.
14178
14179 Example:
14180 openssl ocsp -issuer issuer.pem -cert server.pem \
14181 -host ocsp.issuer.com:80 -respout resp.der
14182 echo "set ssl ocsp-response $(base64 -w 10000 resp.der)" | \
14183 socat stdio /var/run/haproxy.stat
14184
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020014185set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020014186 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
14187 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
14188 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
14189 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020014190 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
14191 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020014192
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014193set timeout cli <delay>
14194 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
14195 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
14196 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
14197
14198set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
14199 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
14200 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090014201 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
14202 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
14203 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
14204 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
14205 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
14206 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
14207 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
14208 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
14209 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
14210 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
14211 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
14212 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
14213 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014214
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014215show errors [<iid>]
14216 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
14217 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020014218 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
14219 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
14220 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014221
14222 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
14223 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
14224 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
14225 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
14226 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
14227 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
14228 are reported too.
14229
14230 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
14231 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
14232 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
14233 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
14234 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
14235 code.
14236
14237 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
14238 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
14239 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
14240 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
14241 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
14242 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
14243 line.
14244
14245 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014246 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
14247 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014248 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
14249 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
14250
14251 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
14252 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
14253 00038 Location: blah\r\n
14254 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
14255 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
14256 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
14257 00204+ minal\r\n
14258 00211 \r\n
14259
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014260 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014261 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
14262 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
14263 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
14264 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
14265 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
14266 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010014267
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014268show info
14269 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
14270
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014271show map [<map>]
14272 Dump info about map converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014273 maps is returned. If a <map> is specified, its contents are dumped. <map> is
14274 the #<id> or <file>. The first column is a unique identifier. It can be used
14275 as reference for the operation "del map" and "set map". The second column is
14276 the pattern and the third column is the sample if available. The data returned
14277 are not directly a list of available maps, but are the list of all patterns
14278 composing any map. Many of these patterns can be shared with ACL.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014279
14280show acl [<acl>]
14281 Dump info about acl converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014282 acls is returned. If a <acl> is specified, its contents are dumped. <acl> if
14283 the #<id> or <file>. The dump format is the same than the map even for the
14284 sample value. The data returned are not a list of available ACL, but are the
14285 list of all patterns composing any ACL. Many of these patterns can be shared
14286 with maps.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014287
Willy Tarreau12833bb2014-01-28 16:49:56 +010014288show pools
14289 Dump the status of internal memory pools. This is useful to track memory
14290 usage when suspecting a memory leak for example. It does exactly the same
14291 as the SIGQUIT when running in foreground except that it does not flush
14292 the pools.
14293
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014294show sess
14295 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020014296 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
14297 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
14298
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010014299show sess <id>
14300 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
14301 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
14302 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
14303 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
14304 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Olivierce31e6e2014-09-05 18:49:10 +020014305 freely evolve depending on demands. You may find a description of all fields
14306 returned in src/dumpstats.c
14307
14308 The special id "all" dumps the states of all sessions, which must be avoided
14309 as much as possible as it is highly CPU intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014310
14311show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
14312 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
14313 possible to dump only selected items :
14314 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
14315 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
14316 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
14317 for example:
14318 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
14319 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
14320 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
14321
14322 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014323 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
14324 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014325 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
14326 Release_date: 2009/09/23
14327 Nbproc: 1
14328 Process_num: 1
14329 (...)
14330
14331 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
14332 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
14333 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
14334 (...)
14335 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
14336
14337 $
14338
14339 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
14340 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
14341 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
14342 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014343 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014344
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014345show table
14346 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
14347 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
14348 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
14349 entries currently in use.
14350
14351 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014352 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014353 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
14354 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014355
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014356show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014357 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
14358 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
14359 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014360 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
14361
14362 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
14363 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
14364 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
14365 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
14366 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
14367
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014368 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
14369 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
14370 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
14371 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
14372 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
14373 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
14374
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090014375
14376 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090014377 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
14378 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014379
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014380 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014381 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014382 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014383 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
14384 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
14385 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14386 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014387
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014388 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014389 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014390 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14391 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014392
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014393 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
14394 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014395 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014396 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14397 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014398
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014399 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
14400 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014401 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014402 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14403 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
14404
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014405 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
14406 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
14407 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
14408 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
14409 time goes, the average event rate drops.
14410
14411 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
14412 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
14413 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014414 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
14415 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014416 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
14417 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020014418
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020014419shutdown frontend <frontend>
14420 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
14421 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
14422 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
14423 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
14424 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
14425 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
14426 once it is terminated.
14427
14428 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
14429 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
14430
14431 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14432 level "admin".
14433
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020014434shutdown session <id>
14435 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
14436 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
14437 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
14438 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
14439 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
14440 flag in the logs.
14441
Cyril Bontée63a1eb2014-07-12 18:22:42 +020014442shutdown sessions server <backend>/<server>
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020014443 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
14444 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
14445 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
14446 'K' flag in the logs.
14447
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014448/*
14449 * Local variables:
14450 * fill-column: 79
14451 * End:
14452 */